re PR bootstrap/51346 (LTO bootstrap failed with bootstrap-profiled)
[official-gcc.git] / gcc / var-tracking.c
blob4e07d25b54a923716a4caf8106bc5c79820783f8
1 /* Variable tracking routines for the GNU compiler.
2 Copyright (C) 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010, 2011
3 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 This file is part of GCC.
7 GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
8 under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option)
10 any later version.
12 GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT
13 ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY
14 or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public
15 License for more details.
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GCC; see the file COPYING3. If not see
19 <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
21 /* This file contains the variable tracking pass. It computes where
22 variables are located (which registers or where in memory) at each position
23 in instruction stream and emits notes describing the locations.
24 Debug information (DWARF2 location lists) is finally generated from
25 these notes.
26 With this debug information, it is possible to show variables
27 even when debugging optimized code.
29 How does the variable tracking pass work?
31 First, it scans RTL code for uses, stores and clobbers (register/memory
32 references in instructions), for call insns and for stack adjustments
33 separately for each basic block and saves them to an array of micro
34 operations.
35 The micro operations of one instruction are ordered so that
36 pre-modifying stack adjustment < use < use with no var < call insn <
37 < clobber < set < post-modifying stack adjustment
39 Then, a forward dataflow analysis is performed to find out how locations
40 of variables change through code and to propagate the variable locations
41 along control flow graph.
42 The IN set for basic block BB is computed as a union of OUT sets of BB's
43 predecessors, the OUT set for BB is copied from the IN set for BB and
44 is changed according to micro operations in BB.
46 The IN and OUT sets for basic blocks consist of a current stack adjustment
47 (used for adjusting offset of variables addressed using stack pointer),
48 the table of structures describing the locations of parts of a variable
49 and for each physical register a linked list for each physical register.
50 The linked list is a list of variable parts stored in the register,
51 i.e. it is a list of triplets (reg, decl, offset) where decl is
52 REG_EXPR (reg) and offset is REG_OFFSET (reg). The linked list is used for
53 effective deleting appropriate variable parts when we set or clobber the
54 register.
56 There may be more than one variable part in a register. The linked lists
57 should be pretty short so it is a good data structure here.
58 For example in the following code, register allocator may assign same
59 register to variables A and B, and both of them are stored in the same
60 register in CODE:
62 if (cond)
63 set A;
64 else
65 set B;
66 CODE;
67 if (cond)
68 use A;
69 else
70 use B;
72 Finally, the NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION notes describing the variable locations
73 are emitted to appropriate positions in RTL code. Each such a note describes
74 the location of one variable at the point in instruction stream where the
75 note is. There is no need to emit a note for each variable before each
76 instruction, we only emit these notes where the location of variable changes
77 (this means that we also emit notes for changes between the OUT set of the
78 previous block and the IN set of the current block).
80 The notes consist of two parts:
81 1. the declaration (from REG_EXPR or MEM_EXPR)
82 2. the location of a variable - it is either a simple register/memory
83 reference (for simple variables, for example int),
84 or a parallel of register/memory references (for a large variables
85 which consist of several parts, for example long long).
89 #include "config.h"
90 #include "system.h"
91 #include "coretypes.h"
92 #include "tm.h"
93 #include "rtl.h"
94 #include "tree.h"
95 #include "tm_p.h"
96 #include "hard-reg-set.h"
97 #include "basic-block.h"
98 #include "flags.h"
99 #include "output.h"
100 #include "insn-config.h"
101 #include "reload.h"
102 #include "sbitmap.h"
103 #include "alloc-pool.h"
104 #include "fibheap.h"
105 #include "hashtab.h"
106 #include "regs.h"
107 #include "expr.h"
108 #include "timevar.h"
109 #include "tree-pass.h"
110 #include "tree-flow.h"
111 #include "cselib.h"
112 #include "target.h"
113 #include "params.h"
114 #include "diagnostic.h"
115 #include "tree-pretty-print.h"
116 #include "pointer-set.h"
117 #include "recog.h"
118 #include "tm_p.h"
120 /* var-tracking.c assumes that tree code with the same value as VALUE rtx code
121 has no chance to appear in REG_EXPR/MEM_EXPRs and isn't a decl.
122 Currently the value is the same as IDENTIFIER_NODE, which has such
123 a property. If this compile time assertion ever fails, make sure that
124 the new tree code that equals (int) VALUE has the same property. */
125 extern char check_value_val[(int) VALUE == (int) IDENTIFIER_NODE ? 1 : -1];
127 /* Type of micro operation. */
128 enum micro_operation_type
130 MO_USE, /* Use location (REG or MEM). */
131 MO_USE_NO_VAR,/* Use location which is not associated with a variable
132 or the variable is not trackable. */
133 MO_VAL_USE, /* Use location which is associated with a value. */
134 MO_VAL_LOC, /* Use location which appears in a debug insn. */
135 MO_VAL_SET, /* Set location associated with a value. */
136 MO_SET, /* Set location. */
137 MO_COPY, /* Copy the same portion of a variable from one
138 location to another. */
139 MO_CLOBBER, /* Clobber location. */
140 MO_CALL, /* Call insn. */
141 MO_ADJUST /* Adjust stack pointer. */
145 static const char * const ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
146 micro_operation_type_name[] = {
147 "MO_USE",
148 "MO_USE_NO_VAR",
149 "MO_VAL_USE",
150 "MO_VAL_LOC",
151 "MO_VAL_SET",
152 "MO_SET",
153 "MO_COPY",
154 "MO_CLOBBER",
155 "MO_CALL",
156 "MO_ADJUST"
159 /* Where shall the note be emitted? BEFORE or AFTER the instruction.
160 Notes emitted as AFTER_CALL are to take effect during the call,
161 rather than after the call. */
162 enum emit_note_where
164 EMIT_NOTE_BEFORE_INSN,
165 EMIT_NOTE_AFTER_INSN,
166 EMIT_NOTE_AFTER_CALL_INSN
169 /* Structure holding information about micro operation. */
170 typedef struct micro_operation_def
172 /* Type of micro operation. */
173 enum micro_operation_type type;
175 /* The instruction which the micro operation is in, for MO_USE,
176 MO_USE_NO_VAR, MO_CALL and MO_ADJUST, or the subsequent
177 instruction or note in the original flow (before any var-tracking
178 notes are inserted, to simplify emission of notes), for MO_SET
179 and MO_CLOBBER. */
180 rtx insn;
182 union {
183 /* Location. For MO_SET and MO_COPY, this is the SET that
184 performs the assignment, if known, otherwise it is the target
185 of the assignment. For MO_VAL_USE and MO_VAL_SET, it is a
186 CONCAT of the VALUE and the LOC associated with it. For
187 MO_VAL_LOC, it is a CONCAT of the VALUE and the VAR_LOCATION
188 associated with it. */
189 rtx loc;
191 /* Stack adjustment. */
192 HOST_WIDE_INT adjust;
193 } u;
194 } micro_operation;
196 DEF_VEC_O(micro_operation);
197 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_O(micro_operation,heap);
199 /* A declaration of a variable, or an RTL value being handled like a
200 declaration. */
201 typedef void *decl_or_value;
203 /* Structure for passing some other parameters to function
204 emit_note_insn_var_location. */
205 typedef struct emit_note_data_def
207 /* The instruction which the note will be emitted before/after. */
208 rtx insn;
210 /* Where the note will be emitted (before/after insn)? */
211 enum emit_note_where where;
213 /* The variables and values active at this point. */
214 htab_t vars;
215 } emit_note_data;
217 /* Description of location of a part of a variable. The content of a physical
218 register is described by a chain of these structures.
219 The chains are pretty short (usually 1 or 2 elements) and thus
220 chain is the best data structure. */
221 typedef struct attrs_def
223 /* Pointer to next member of the list. */
224 struct attrs_def *next;
226 /* The rtx of register. */
227 rtx loc;
229 /* The declaration corresponding to LOC. */
230 decl_or_value dv;
232 /* Offset from start of DECL. */
233 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
234 } *attrs;
236 /* Structure holding a refcounted hash table. If refcount > 1,
237 it must be first unshared before modified. */
238 typedef struct shared_hash_def
240 /* Reference count. */
241 int refcount;
243 /* Actual hash table. */
244 htab_t htab;
245 } *shared_hash;
247 /* Structure holding the IN or OUT set for a basic block. */
248 typedef struct dataflow_set_def
250 /* Adjustment of stack offset. */
251 HOST_WIDE_INT stack_adjust;
253 /* Attributes for registers (lists of attrs). */
254 attrs regs[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
256 /* Variable locations. */
257 shared_hash vars;
259 /* Vars that is being traversed. */
260 shared_hash traversed_vars;
261 } dataflow_set;
263 /* The structure (one for each basic block) containing the information
264 needed for variable tracking. */
265 typedef struct variable_tracking_info_def
267 /* The vector of micro operations. */
268 VEC(micro_operation, heap) *mos;
270 /* The IN and OUT set for dataflow analysis. */
271 dataflow_set in;
272 dataflow_set out;
274 /* The permanent-in dataflow set for this block. This is used to
275 hold values for which we had to compute entry values. ??? This
276 should probably be dynamically allocated, to avoid using more
277 memory in non-debug builds. */
278 dataflow_set *permp;
280 /* Has the block been visited in DFS? */
281 bool visited;
283 /* Has the block been flooded in VTA? */
284 bool flooded;
286 } *variable_tracking_info;
288 /* Structure for chaining the locations. */
289 typedef struct location_chain_def
291 /* Next element in the chain. */
292 struct location_chain_def *next;
294 /* The location (REG, MEM or VALUE). */
295 rtx loc;
297 /* The "value" stored in this location. */
298 rtx set_src;
300 /* Initialized? */
301 enum var_init_status init;
302 } *location_chain;
304 /* A vector of loc_exp_dep holds the active dependencies of a one-part
305 DV on VALUEs, i.e., the VALUEs expanded so as to form the current
306 location of DV. Each entry is also part of VALUE' s linked-list of
307 backlinks back to DV. */
308 typedef struct loc_exp_dep_s
310 /* The dependent DV. */
311 decl_or_value dv;
312 /* The dependency VALUE or DECL_DEBUG. */
313 rtx value;
314 /* The next entry in VALUE's backlinks list. */
315 struct loc_exp_dep_s *next;
316 /* A pointer to the pointer to this entry (head or prev's next) in
317 the doubly-linked list. */
318 struct loc_exp_dep_s **pprev;
319 } loc_exp_dep;
321 DEF_VEC_O (loc_exp_dep);
323 /* This data structure is allocated for one-part variables at the time
324 of emitting notes. */
325 struct onepart_aux
327 /* Doubly-linked list of dependent DVs. These are DVs whose cur_loc
328 computation used the expansion of this variable, and that ought
329 to be notified should this variable change. If the DV's cur_loc
330 expanded to NULL, all components of the loc list are regarded as
331 active, so that any changes in them give us a chance to get a
332 location. Otherwise, only components of the loc that expanded to
333 non-NULL are regarded as active dependencies. */
334 loc_exp_dep *backlinks;
335 /* This holds the LOC that was expanded into cur_loc. We need only
336 mark a one-part variable as changed if the FROM loc is removed,
337 or if it has no known location and a loc is added, or if it gets
338 a change notification from any of its active dependencies. */
339 rtx from;
340 /* The depth of the cur_loc expression. */
341 int depth;
342 /* Dependencies actively used when expand FROM into cur_loc. */
343 VEC (loc_exp_dep, none) deps;
346 /* Structure describing one part of variable. */
347 typedef struct variable_part_def
349 /* Chain of locations of the part. */
350 location_chain loc_chain;
352 /* Location which was last emitted to location list. */
353 rtx cur_loc;
355 union variable_aux
357 /* The offset in the variable, if !var->onepart. */
358 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
360 /* Pointer to auxiliary data, if var->onepart and emit_notes. */
361 struct onepart_aux *onepaux;
362 } aux;
363 } variable_part;
365 /* Maximum number of location parts. */
366 #define MAX_VAR_PARTS 16
368 /* Enumeration type used to discriminate various types of one-part
369 variables. */
370 typedef enum onepart_enum
372 /* Not a one-part variable. */
373 NOT_ONEPART = 0,
374 /* A one-part DECL that is not a DEBUG_EXPR_DECL. */
375 ONEPART_VDECL = 1,
376 /* A DEBUG_EXPR_DECL. */
377 ONEPART_DEXPR = 2,
378 /* A VALUE. */
379 ONEPART_VALUE = 3
380 } onepart_enum_t;
382 /* Structure describing where the variable is located. */
383 typedef struct variable_def
385 /* The declaration of the variable, or an RTL value being handled
386 like a declaration. */
387 decl_or_value dv;
389 /* Reference count. */
390 int refcount;
392 /* Number of variable parts. */
393 char n_var_parts;
395 /* What type of DV this is, according to enum onepart_enum. */
396 ENUM_BITFIELD (onepart_enum) onepart : CHAR_BIT;
398 /* True if this variable_def struct is currently in the
399 changed_variables hash table. */
400 bool in_changed_variables;
402 /* The variable parts. */
403 variable_part var_part[1];
404 } *variable;
405 typedef const struct variable_def *const_variable;
407 /* Pointer to the BB's information specific to variable tracking pass. */
408 #define VTI(BB) ((variable_tracking_info) (BB)->aux)
410 /* Macro to access MEM_OFFSET as an HOST_WIDE_INT. Evaluates MEM twice. */
411 #define INT_MEM_OFFSET(mem) (MEM_OFFSET_KNOWN_P (mem) ? MEM_OFFSET (mem) : 0)
413 #if ENABLE_CHECKING && (GCC_VERSION >= 2007)
415 /* Access VAR's Ith part's offset, checking that it's not a one-part
416 variable. */
417 #define VAR_PART_OFFSET(var, i) __extension__ \
418 (*({ variable const __v = (var); \
419 gcc_checking_assert (!__v->onepart); \
420 &__v->var_part[(i)].aux.offset; }))
422 /* Access VAR's one-part auxiliary data, checking that it is a
423 one-part variable. */
424 #define VAR_LOC_1PAUX(var) __extension__ \
425 (*({ variable const __v = (var); \
426 gcc_checking_assert (__v->onepart); \
427 &__v->var_part[0].aux.onepaux; }))
429 #else
430 #define VAR_PART_OFFSET(var, i) ((var)->var_part[(i)].aux.offset)
431 #define VAR_LOC_1PAUX(var) ((var)->var_part[0].aux.onepaux)
432 #endif
434 /* These are accessor macros for the one-part auxiliary data. When
435 convenient for users, they're guarded by tests that the data was
436 allocated. */
437 #define VAR_LOC_DEP_LST(var) (VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var) \
438 ? VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var)->backlinks \
439 : NULL)
440 #define VAR_LOC_DEP_LSTP(var) (VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var) \
441 ? &VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var)->backlinks \
442 : NULL)
443 #define VAR_LOC_FROM(var) (VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var)->from)
444 #define VAR_LOC_DEPTH(var) (VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var)->depth)
445 #define VAR_LOC_DEP_VEC(var) (VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var) \
446 ? &VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var)->deps \
447 : NULL)
449 /* Alloc pool for struct attrs_def. */
450 static alloc_pool attrs_pool;
452 /* Alloc pool for struct variable_def with MAX_VAR_PARTS entries. */
453 static alloc_pool var_pool;
455 /* Alloc pool for struct variable_def with a single var_part entry. */
456 static alloc_pool valvar_pool;
458 /* Alloc pool for struct location_chain_def. */
459 static alloc_pool loc_chain_pool;
461 /* Alloc pool for struct shared_hash_def. */
462 static alloc_pool shared_hash_pool;
464 /* Changed variables, notes will be emitted for them. */
465 static htab_t changed_variables;
467 /* Shall notes be emitted? */
468 static bool emit_notes;
470 /* Values whose dynamic location lists have gone empty, but whose
471 cselib location lists are still usable. Use this to hold the
472 current location, the backlinks, etc, during emit_notes. */
473 static htab_t dropped_values;
475 /* Empty shared hashtable. */
476 static shared_hash empty_shared_hash;
478 /* Scratch register bitmap used by cselib_expand_value_rtx. */
479 static bitmap scratch_regs = NULL;
481 #ifdef HAVE_window_save
482 typedef struct GTY(()) parm_reg {
483 rtx outgoing;
484 rtx incoming;
485 } parm_reg_t;
487 DEF_VEC_O(parm_reg_t);
488 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_O(parm_reg_t, gc);
490 /* Vector of windowed parameter registers, if any. */
491 static VEC(parm_reg_t, gc) *windowed_parm_regs = NULL;
492 #endif
494 /* Variable used to tell whether cselib_process_insn called our hook. */
495 static bool cselib_hook_called;
497 /* Local function prototypes. */
498 static void stack_adjust_offset_pre_post (rtx, HOST_WIDE_INT *,
499 HOST_WIDE_INT *);
500 static void insn_stack_adjust_offset_pre_post (rtx, HOST_WIDE_INT *,
501 HOST_WIDE_INT *);
502 static bool vt_stack_adjustments (void);
503 static hashval_t variable_htab_hash (const void *);
504 static int variable_htab_eq (const void *, const void *);
505 static void variable_htab_free (void *);
507 static void init_attrs_list_set (attrs *);
508 static void attrs_list_clear (attrs *);
509 static attrs attrs_list_member (attrs, decl_or_value, HOST_WIDE_INT);
510 static void attrs_list_insert (attrs *, decl_or_value, HOST_WIDE_INT, rtx);
511 static void attrs_list_copy (attrs *, attrs);
512 static void attrs_list_union (attrs *, attrs);
514 static void **unshare_variable (dataflow_set *set, void **slot, variable var,
515 enum var_init_status);
516 static void vars_copy (htab_t, htab_t);
517 static tree var_debug_decl (tree);
518 static void var_reg_set (dataflow_set *, rtx, enum var_init_status, rtx);
519 static void var_reg_delete_and_set (dataflow_set *, rtx, bool,
520 enum var_init_status, rtx);
521 static void var_reg_delete (dataflow_set *, rtx, bool);
522 static void var_regno_delete (dataflow_set *, int);
523 static void var_mem_set (dataflow_set *, rtx, enum var_init_status, rtx);
524 static void var_mem_delete_and_set (dataflow_set *, rtx, bool,
525 enum var_init_status, rtx);
526 static void var_mem_delete (dataflow_set *, rtx, bool);
528 static void dataflow_set_init (dataflow_set *);
529 static void dataflow_set_clear (dataflow_set *);
530 static void dataflow_set_copy (dataflow_set *, dataflow_set *);
531 static int variable_union_info_cmp_pos (const void *, const void *);
532 static void dataflow_set_union (dataflow_set *, dataflow_set *);
533 static location_chain find_loc_in_1pdv (rtx, variable, htab_t);
534 static bool canon_value_cmp (rtx, rtx);
535 static int loc_cmp (rtx, rtx);
536 static bool variable_part_different_p (variable_part *, variable_part *);
537 static bool onepart_variable_different_p (variable, variable);
538 static bool variable_different_p (variable, variable);
539 static bool dataflow_set_different (dataflow_set *, dataflow_set *);
540 static void dataflow_set_destroy (dataflow_set *);
542 static bool contains_symbol_ref (rtx);
543 static bool track_expr_p (tree, bool);
544 static bool same_variable_part_p (rtx, tree, HOST_WIDE_INT);
545 static int add_uses (rtx *, void *);
546 static void add_uses_1 (rtx *, void *);
547 static void add_stores (rtx, const_rtx, void *);
548 static bool compute_bb_dataflow (basic_block);
549 static bool vt_find_locations (void);
551 static void dump_attrs_list (attrs);
552 static int dump_var_slot (void **, void *);
553 static void dump_var (variable);
554 static void dump_vars (htab_t);
555 static void dump_dataflow_set (dataflow_set *);
556 static void dump_dataflow_sets (void);
558 static void set_dv_changed (decl_or_value, bool);
559 static void variable_was_changed (variable, dataflow_set *);
560 static void **set_slot_part (dataflow_set *, rtx, void **,
561 decl_or_value, HOST_WIDE_INT,
562 enum var_init_status, rtx);
563 static void set_variable_part (dataflow_set *, rtx,
564 decl_or_value, HOST_WIDE_INT,
565 enum var_init_status, rtx, enum insert_option);
566 static void **clobber_slot_part (dataflow_set *, rtx,
567 void **, HOST_WIDE_INT, rtx);
568 static void clobber_variable_part (dataflow_set *, rtx,
569 decl_or_value, HOST_WIDE_INT, rtx);
570 static void **delete_slot_part (dataflow_set *, rtx, void **, HOST_WIDE_INT);
571 static void delete_variable_part (dataflow_set *, rtx,
572 decl_or_value, HOST_WIDE_INT);
573 static int emit_note_insn_var_location (void **, void *);
574 static void emit_notes_for_changes (rtx, enum emit_note_where, shared_hash);
575 static int emit_notes_for_differences_1 (void **, void *);
576 static int emit_notes_for_differences_2 (void **, void *);
577 static void emit_notes_for_differences (rtx, dataflow_set *, dataflow_set *);
578 static void emit_notes_in_bb (basic_block, dataflow_set *);
579 static void vt_emit_notes (void);
581 static bool vt_get_decl_and_offset (rtx, tree *, HOST_WIDE_INT *);
582 static void vt_add_function_parameters (void);
583 static bool vt_initialize (void);
584 static void vt_finalize (void);
586 /* Given a SET, calculate the amount of stack adjustment it contains
587 PRE- and POST-modifying stack pointer.
588 This function is similar to stack_adjust_offset. */
590 static void
591 stack_adjust_offset_pre_post (rtx pattern, HOST_WIDE_INT *pre,
592 HOST_WIDE_INT *post)
594 rtx src = SET_SRC (pattern);
595 rtx dest = SET_DEST (pattern);
596 enum rtx_code code;
598 if (dest == stack_pointer_rtx)
600 /* (set (reg sp) (plus (reg sp) (const_int))) */
601 code = GET_CODE (src);
602 if (! (code == PLUS || code == MINUS)
603 || XEXP (src, 0) != stack_pointer_rtx
604 || !CONST_INT_P (XEXP (src, 1)))
605 return;
607 if (code == MINUS)
608 *post += INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
609 else
610 *post -= INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
612 else if (MEM_P (dest))
614 /* (set (mem (pre_dec (reg sp))) (foo)) */
615 src = XEXP (dest, 0);
616 code = GET_CODE (src);
618 switch (code)
620 case PRE_MODIFY:
621 case POST_MODIFY:
622 if (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
624 rtx val = XEXP (XEXP (src, 1), 1);
625 /* We handle only adjustments by constant amount. */
626 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == PLUS &&
627 CONST_INT_P (val));
629 if (code == PRE_MODIFY)
630 *pre -= INTVAL (val);
631 else
632 *post -= INTVAL (val);
633 break;
635 return;
637 case PRE_DEC:
638 if (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
640 *pre += GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
641 break;
643 return;
645 case POST_DEC:
646 if (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
648 *post += GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
649 break;
651 return;
653 case PRE_INC:
654 if (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
656 *pre -= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
657 break;
659 return;
661 case POST_INC:
662 if (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
664 *post -= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
665 break;
667 return;
669 default:
670 return;
675 /* Given an INSN, calculate the amount of stack adjustment it contains
676 PRE- and POST-modifying stack pointer. */
678 static void
679 insn_stack_adjust_offset_pre_post (rtx insn, HOST_WIDE_INT *pre,
680 HOST_WIDE_INT *post)
682 rtx pattern;
684 *pre = 0;
685 *post = 0;
687 pattern = PATTERN (insn);
688 if (RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn))
690 rtx expr = find_reg_note (insn, REG_FRAME_RELATED_EXPR, NULL_RTX);
691 if (expr)
692 pattern = XEXP (expr, 0);
695 if (GET_CODE (pattern) == SET)
696 stack_adjust_offset_pre_post (pattern, pre, post);
697 else if (GET_CODE (pattern) == PARALLEL
698 || GET_CODE (pattern) == SEQUENCE)
700 int i;
702 /* There may be stack adjustments inside compound insns. Search
703 for them. */
704 for ( i = XVECLEN (pattern, 0) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
705 if (GET_CODE (XVECEXP (pattern, 0, i)) == SET)
706 stack_adjust_offset_pre_post (XVECEXP (pattern, 0, i), pre, post);
710 /* Compute stack adjustments for all blocks by traversing DFS tree.
711 Return true when the adjustments on all incoming edges are consistent.
712 Heavily borrowed from pre_and_rev_post_order_compute. */
714 static bool
715 vt_stack_adjustments (void)
717 edge_iterator *stack;
718 int sp;
720 /* Initialize entry block. */
721 VTI (ENTRY_BLOCK_PTR)->visited = true;
722 VTI (ENTRY_BLOCK_PTR)->in.stack_adjust = INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET;
723 VTI (ENTRY_BLOCK_PTR)->out.stack_adjust = INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET;
725 /* Allocate stack for back-tracking up CFG. */
726 stack = XNEWVEC (edge_iterator, n_basic_blocks + 1);
727 sp = 0;
729 /* Push the first edge on to the stack. */
730 stack[sp++] = ei_start (ENTRY_BLOCK_PTR->succs);
732 while (sp)
734 edge_iterator ei;
735 basic_block src;
736 basic_block dest;
738 /* Look at the edge on the top of the stack. */
739 ei = stack[sp - 1];
740 src = ei_edge (ei)->src;
741 dest = ei_edge (ei)->dest;
743 /* Check if the edge destination has been visited yet. */
744 if (!VTI (dest)->visited)
746 rtx insn;
747 HOST_WIDE_INT pre, post, offset;
748 VTI (dest)->visited = true;
749 VTI (dest)->in.stack_adjust = offset = VTI (src)->out.stack_adjust;
751 if (dest != EXIT_BLOCK_PTR)
752 for (insn = BB_HEAD (dest);
753 insn != NEXT_INSN (BB_END (dest));
754 insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
755 if (INSN_P (insn))
757 insn_stack_adjust_offset_pre_post (insn, &pre, &post);
758 offset += pre + post;
761 VTI (dest)->out.stack_adjust = offset;
763 if (EDGE_COUNT (dest->succs) > 0)
764 /* Since the DEST node has been visited for the first
765 time, check its successors. */
766 stack[sp++] = ei_start (dest->succs);
768 else
770 /* Check whether the adjustments on the edges are the same. */
771 if (VTI (dest)->in.stack_adjust != VTI (src)->out.stack_adjust)
773 free (stack);
774 return false;
777 if (! ei_one_before_end_p (ei))
778 /* Go to the next edge. */
779 ei_next (&stack[sp - 1]);
780 else
781 /* Return to previous level if there are no more edges. */
782 sp--;
786 free (stack);
787 return true;
790 /* arg_pointer_rtx resp. frame_pointer_rtx if stack_pointer_rtx or
791 hard_frame_pointer_rtx is being mapped to it and offset for it. */
792 static rtx cfa_base_rtx;
793 static HOST_WIDE_INT cfa_base_offset;
795 /* Compute a CFA-based value for an ADJUSTMENT made to stack_pointer_rtx
796 or hard_frame_pointer_rtx. */
798 static inline rtx
799 compute_cfa_pointer (HOST_WIDE_INT adjustment)
801 return plus_constant (cfa_base_rtx, adjustment + cfa_base_offset);
804 /* Adjustment for hard_frame_pointer_rtx to cfa base reg,
805 or -1 if the replacement shouldn't be done. */
806 static HOST_WIDE_INT hard_frame_pointer_adjustment = -1;
808 /* Data for adjust_mems callback. */
810 struct adjust_mem_data
812 bool store;
813 enum machine_mode mem_mode;
814 HOST_WIDE_INT stack_adjust;
815 rtx side_effects;
818 /* Helper for adjust_mems. Return 1 if *loc is unsuitable for
819 transformation of wider mode arithmetics to narrower mode,
820 -1 if it is suitable and subexpressions shouldn't be
821 traversed and 0 if it is suitable and subexpressions should
822 be traversed. Called through for_each_rtx. */
824 static int
825 use_narrower_mode_test (rtx *loc, void *data)
827 rtx subreg = (rtx) data;
829 if (CONSTANT_P (*loc))
830 return -1;
831 switch (GET_CODE (*loc))
833 case REG:
834 if (cselib_lookup (*loc, GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (subreg)), 0, VOIDmode))
835 return 1;
836 if (!validate_subreg (GET_MODE (subreg), GET_MODE (*loc),
837 *loc, subreg_lowpart_offset (GET_MODE (subreg),
838 GET_MODE (*loc))))
839 return 1;
840 return -1;
841 case PLUS:
842 case MINUS:
843 case MULT:
844 return 0;
845 case ASHIFT:
846 if (for_each_rtx (&XEXP (*loc, 0), use_narrower_mode_test, data))
847 return 1;
848 else
849 return -1;
850 default:
851 return 1;
855 /* Transform X into narrower mode MODE from wider mode WMODE. */
857 static rtx
858 use_narrower_mode (rtx x, enum machine_mode mode, enum machine_mode wmode)
860 rtx op0, op1;
861 if (CONSTANT_P (x))
862 return lowpart_subreg (mode, x, wmode);
863 switch (GET_CODE (x))
865 case REG:
866 return lowpart_subreg (mode, x, wmode);
867 case PLUS:
868 case MINUS:
869 case MULT:
870 op0 = use_narrower_mode (XEXP (x, 0), mode, wmode);
871 op1 = use_narrower_mode (XEXP (x, 1), mode, wmode);
872 return simplify_gen_binary (GET_CODE (x), mode, op0, op1);
873 case ASHIFT:
874 op0 = use_narrower_mode (XEXP (x, 0), mode, wmode);
875 return simplify_gen_binary (ASHIFT, mode, op0, XEXP (x, 1));
876 default:
877 gcc_unreachable ();
881 /* Helper function for adjusting used MEMs. */
883 static rtx
884 adjust_mems (rtx loc, const_rtx old_rtx, void *data)
886 struct adjust_mem_data *amd = (struct adjust_mem_data *) data;
887 rtx mem, addr = loc, tem;
888 enum machine_mode mem_mode_save;
889 bool store_save;
890 switch (GET_CODE (loc))
892 case REG:
893 /* Don't do any sp or fp replacements outside of MEM addresses
894 on the LHS. */
895 if (amd->mem_mode == VOIDmode && amd->store)
896 return loc;
897 if (loc == stack_pointer_rtx
898 && !frame_pointer_needed
899 && cfa_base_rtx)
900 return compute_cfa_pointer (amd->stack_adjust);
901 else if (loc == hard_frame_pointer_rtx
902 && frame_pointer_needed
903 && hard_frame_pointer_adjustment != -1
904 && cfa_base_rtx)
905 return compute_cfa_pointer (hard_frame_pointer_adjustment);
906 gcc_checking_assert (loc != virtual_incoming_args_rtx);
907 return loc;
908 case MEM:
909 mem = loc;
910 if (!amd->store)
912 mem = targetm.delegitimize_address (mem);
913 if (mem != loc && !MEM_P (mem))
914 return simplify_replace_fn_rtx (mem, old_rtx, adjust_mems, data);
917 addr = XEXP (mem, 0);
918 mem_mode_save = amd->mem_mode;
919 amd->mem_mode = GET_MODE (mem);
920 store_save = amd->store;
921 amd->store = false;
922 addr = simplify_replace_fn_rtx (addr, old_rtx, adjust_mems, data);
923 amd->store = store_save;
924 amd->mem_mode = mem_mode_save;
925 if (mem == loc)
926 addr = targetm.delegitimize_address (addr);
927 if (addr != XEXP (mem, 0))
928 mem = replace_equiv_address_nv (mem, addr);
929 if (!amd->store)
930 mem = avoid_constant_pool_reference (mem);
931 return mem;
932 case PRE_INC:
933 case PRE_DEC:
934 addr = gen_rtx_PLUS (GET_MODE (loc), XEXP (loc, 0),
935 GEN_INT (GET_CODE (loc) == PRE_INC
936 ? GET_MODE_SIZE (amd->mem_mode)
937 : -GET_MODE_SIZE (amd->mem_mode)));
938 case POST_INC:
939 case POST_DEC:
940 if (addr == loc)
941 addr = XEXP (loc, 0);
942 gcc_assert (amd->mem_mode != VOIDmode && amd->mem_mode != BLKmode);
943 addr = simplify_replace_fn_rtx (addr, old_rtx, adjust_mems, data);
944 tem = gen_rtx_PLUS (GET_MODE (loc), XEXP (loc, 0),
945 GEN_INT ((GET_CODE (loc) == PRE_INC
946 || GET_CODE (loc) == POST_INC)
947 ? GET_MODE_SIZE (amd->mem_mode)
948 : -GET_MODE_SIZE (amd->mem_mode)));
949 amd->side_effects = alloc_EXPR_LIST (0,
950 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode,
951 XEXP (loc, 0),
952 tem),
953 amd->side_effects);
954 return addr;
955 case PRE_MODIFY:
956 addr = XEXP (loc, 1);
957 case POST_MODIFY:
958 if (addr == loc)
959 addr = XEXP (loc, 0);
960 gcc_assert (amd->mem_mode != VOIDmode);
961 addr = simplify_replace_fn_rtx (addr, old_rtx, adjust_mems, data);
962 amd->side_effects = alloc_EXPR_LIST (0,
963 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode,
964 XEXP (loc, 0),
965 XEXP (loc, 1)),
966 amd->side_effects);
967 return addr;
968 case SUBREG:
969 /* First try without delegitimization of whole MEMs and
970 avoid_constant_pool_reference, which is more likely to succeed. */
971 store_save = amd->store;
972 amd->store = true;
973 addr = simplify_replace_fn_rtx (SUBREG_REG (loc), old_rtx, adjust_mems,
974 data);
975 amd->store = store_save;
976 mem = simplify_replace_fn_rtx (addr, old_rtx, adjust_mems, data);
977 if (mem == SUBREG_REG (loc))
979 tem = loc;
980 goto finish_subreg;
982 tem = simplify_gen_subreg (GET_MODE (loc), mem,
983 GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (loc)),
984 SUBREG_BYTE (loc));
985 if (tem)
986 goto finish_subreg;
987 tem = simplify_gen_subreg (GET_MODE (loc), addr,
988 GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (loc)),
989 SUBREG_BYTE (loc));
990 if (tem == NULL_RTX)
991 tem = gen_rtx_raw_SUBREG (GET_MODE (loc), addr, SUBREG_BYTE (loc));
992 finish_subreg:
993 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_INSNS
994 && GET_CODE (tem) == SUBREG
995 && (GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (tem)) == PLUS
996 || GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (tem)) == MINUS
997 || GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (tem)) == MULT
998 || GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (tem)) == ASHIFT)
999 && GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (tem)) == MODE_INT
1000 && GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (tem))) == MODE_INT
1001 && GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (tem))
1002 < GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (tem)))
1003 && subreg_lowpart_p (tem)
1004 && !for_each_rtx (&SUBREG_REG (tem), use_narrower_mode_test, tem))
1005 return use_narrower_mode (SUBREG_REG (tem), GET_MODE (tem),
1006 GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (tem)));
1007 return tem;
1008 case ASM_OPERANDS:
1009 /* Don't do any replacements in second and following
1010 ASM_OPERANDS of inline-asm with multiple sets.
1011 ASM_OPERANDS_INPUT_VEC, ASM_OPERANDS_INPUT_CONSTRAINT_VEC
1012 and ASM_OPERANDS_LABEL_VEC need to be equal between
1013 all the ASM_OPERANDs in the insn and adjust_insn will
1014 fix this up. */
1015 if (ASM_OPERANDS_OUTPUT_IDX (loc) != 0)
1016 return loc;
1017 break;
1018 default:
1019 break;
1021 return NULL_RTX;
1024 /* Helper function for replacement of uses. */
1026 static void
1027 adjust_mem_uses (rtx *x, void *data)
1029 rtx new_x = simplify_replace_fn_rtx (*x, NULL_RTX, adjust_mems, data);
1030 if (new_x != *x)
1031 validate_change (NULL_RTX, x, new_x, true);
1034 /* Helper function for replacement of stores. */
1036 static void
1037 adjust_mem_stores (rtx loc, const_rtx expr, void *data)
1039 if (MEM_P (loc))
1041 rtx new_dest = simplify_replace_fn_rtx (SET_DEST (expr), NULL_RTX,
1042 adjust_mems, data);
1043 if (new_dest != SET_DEST (expr))
1045 rtx xexpr = CONST_CAST_RTX (expr);
1046 validate_change (NULL_RTX, &SET_DEST (xexpr), new_dest, true);
1051 /* Simplify INSN. Remove all {PRE,POST}_{INC,DEC,MODIFY} rtxes,
1052 replace them with their value in the insn and add the side-effects
1053 as other sets to the insn. */
1055 static void
1056 adjust_insn (basic_block bb, rtx insn)
1058 struct adjust_mem_data amd;
1059 rtx set;
1061 #ifdef HAVE_window_save
1062 /* If the target machine has an explicit window save instruction, the
1063 transformation OUTGOING_REGNO -> INCOMING_REGNO is done there. */
1064 if (RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn)
1065 && find_reg_note (insn, REG_CFA_WINDOW_SAVE, NULL_RTX))
1067 unsigned int i, nregs = VEC_length(parm_reg_t, windowed_parm_regs);
1068 rtx rtl = gen_rtx_PARALLEL (VOIDmode, rtvec_alloc (nregs * 2));
1069 parm_reg_t *p;
1071 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (parm_reg_t, windowed_parm_regs, i, p)
1073 XVECEXP (rtl, 0, i * 2)
1074 = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, p->incoming, p->outgoing);
1075 /* Do not clobber the attached DECL, but only the REG. */
1076 XVECEXP (rtl, 0, i * 2 + 1)
1077 = gen_rtx_CLOBBER (GET_MODE (p->outgoing),
1078 gen_raw_REG (GET_MODE (p->outgoing),
1079 REGNO (p->outgoing)));
1082 validate_change (NULL_RTX, &PATTERN (insn), rtl, true);
1083 return;
1085 #endif
1087 amd.mem_mode = VOIDmode;
1088 amd.stack_adjust = -VTI (bb)->out.stack_adjust;
1089 amd.side_effects = NULL_RTX;
1091 amd.store = true;
1092 note_stores (PATTERN (insn), adjust_mem_stores, &amd);
1094 amd.store = false;
1095 if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == PARALLEL
1096 && asm_noperands (PATTERN (insn)) > 0
1097 && GET_CODE (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, 0)) == SET)
1099 rtx body, set0;
1100 int i;
1102 /* inline-asm with multiple sets is tiny bit more complicated,
1103 because the 3 vectors in ASM_OPERANDS need to be shared between
1104 all ASM_OPERANDS in the instruction. adjust_mems will
1105 not touch ASM_OPERANDS other than the first one, asm_noperands
1106 test above needs to be called before that (otherwise it would fail)
1107 and afterwards this code fixes it up. */
1108 note_uses (&PATTERN (insn), adjust_mem_uses, &amd);
1109 body = PATTERN (insn);
1110 set0 = XVECEXP (body, 0, 0);
1111 gcc_checking_assert (GET_CODE (set0) == SET
1112 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (set0)) == ASM_OPERANDS
1113 && ASM_OPERANDS_OUTPUT_IDX (SET_SRC (set0)) == 0);
1114 for (i = 1; i < XVECLEN (body, 0); i++)
1115 if (GET_CODE (XVECEXP (body, 0, i)) != SET)
1116 break;
1117 else
1119 set = XVECEXP (body, 0, i);
1120 gcc_checking_assert (GET_CODE (SET_SRC (set)) == ASM_OPERANDS
1121 && ASM_OPERANDS_OUTPUT_IDX (SET_SRC (set))
1122 == i);
1123 if (ASM_OPERANDS_INPUT_VEC (SET_SRC (set))
1124 != ASM_OPERANDS_INPUT_VEC (SET_SRC (set0))
1125 || ASM_OPERANDS_INPUT_CONSTRAINT_VEC (SET_SRC (set))
1126 != ASM_OPERANDS_INPUT_CONSTRAINT_VEC (SET_SRC (set0))
1127 || ASM_OPERANDS_LABEL_VEC (SET_SRC (set))
1128 != ASM_OPERANDS_LABEL_VEC (SET_SRC (set0)))
1130 rtx newsrc = shallow_copy_rtx (SET_SRC (set));
1131 ASM_OPERANDS_INPUT_VEC (newsrc)
1132 = ASM_OPERANDS_INPUT_VEC (SET_SRC (set0));
1133 ASM_OPERANDS_INPUT_CONSTRAINT_VEC (newsrc)
1134 = ASM_OPERANDS_INPUT_CONSTRAINT_VEC (SET_SRC (set0));
1135 ASM_OPERANDS_LABEL_VEC (newsrc)
1136 = ASM_OPERANDS_LABEL_VEC (SET_SRC (set0));
1137 validate_change (NULL_RTX, &SET_SRC (set), newsrc, true);
1141 else
1142 note_uses (&PATTERN (insn), adjust_mem_uses, &amd);
1144 /* For read-only MEMs containing some constant, prefer those
1145 constants. */
1146 set = single_set (insn);
1147 if (set && MEM_P (SET_SRC (set)) && MEM_READONLY_P (SET_SRC (set)))
1149 rtx note = find_reg_equal_equiv_note (insn);
1151 if (note && CONSTANT_P (XEXP (note, 0)))
1152 validate_change (NULL_RTX, &SET_SRC (set), XEXP (note, 0), true);
1155 if (amd.side_effects)
1157 rtx *pat, new_pat, s;
1158 int i, oldn, newn;
1160 pat = &PATTERN (insn);
1161 if (GET_CODE (*pat) == COND_EXEC)
1162 pat = &COND_EXEC_CODE (*pat);
1163 if (GET_CODE (*pat) == PARALLEL)
1164 oldn = XVECLEN (*pat, 0);
1165 else
1166 oldn = 1;
1167 for (s = amd.side_effects, newn = 0; s; newn++)
1168 s = XEXP (s, 1);
1169 new_pat = gen_rtx_PARALLEL (VOIDmode, rtvec_alloc (oldn + newn));
1170 if (GET_CODE (*pat) == PARALLEL)
1171 for (i = 0; i < oldn; i++)
1172 XVECEXP (new_pat, 0, i) = XVECEXP (*pat, 0, i);
1173 else
1174 XVECEXP (new_pat, 0, 0) = *pat;
1175 for (s = amd.side_effects, i = oldn; i < oldn + newn; i++, s = XEXP (s, 1))
1176 XVECEXP (new_pat, 0, i) = XEXP (s, 0);
1177 free_EXPR_LIST_list (&amd.side_effects);
1178 validate_change (NULL_RTX, pat, new_pat, true);
1182 /* Return true if a decl_or_value DV is a DECL or NULL. */
1183 static inline bool
1184 dv_is_decl_p (decl_or_value dv)
1186 return !dv || (int) TREE_CODE ((tree) dv) != (int) VALUE;
1189 /* Return true if a decl_or_value is a VALUE rtl. */
1190 static inline bool
1191 dv_is_value_p (decl_or_value dv)
1193 return dv && !dv_is_decl_p (dv);
1196 /* Return the decl in the decl_or_value. */
1197 static inline tree
1198 dv_as_decl (decl_or_value dv)
1200 gcc_checking_assert (dv_is_decl_p (dv));
1201 return (tree) dv;
1204 /* Return the value in the decl_or_value. */
1205 static inline rtx
1206 dv_as_value (decl_or_value dv)
1208 gcc_checking_assert (dv_is_value_p (dv));
1209 return (rtx)dv;
1212 /* Return the DEBUG_EXPR of a DEBUG_EXPR_DECL or the VALUE in DV. */
1213 static inline rtx
1214 dv_as_rtx (decl_or_value dv)
1216 tree decl;
1218 if (dv_is_value_p (dv))
1219 return dv_as_value (dv);
1221 decl = dv_as_decl (dv);
1223 gcc_checking_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == DEBUG_EXPR_DECL);
1224 return DECL_RTL_KNOWN_SET (decl);
1227 /* Return the opaque pointer in the decl_or_value. */
1228 static inline void *
1229 dv_as_opaque (decl_or_value dv)
1231 return dv;
1234 /* Return nonzero if a decl_or_value must not have more than one
1235 variable part. The returned value discriminates among various
1236 kinds of one-part DVs ccording to enum onepart_enum. */
1237 static inline onepart_enum_t
1238 dv_onepart_p (decl_or_value dv)
1240 tree decl;
1242 if (!MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_INSNS)
1243 return NOT_ONEPART;
1245 if (dv_is_value_p (dv))
1246 return ONEPART_VALUE;
1248 decl = dv_as_decl (dv);
1250 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == DEBUG_EXPR_DECL)
1251 return ONEPART_DEXPR;
1253 if (target_for_debug_bind (decl) != NULL_TREE)
1254 return ONEPART_VDECL;
1256 return NOT_ONEPART;
1259 /* Return the variable pool to be used for a dv of type ONEPART. */
1260 static inline alloc_pool
1261 onepart_pool (onepart_enum_t onepart)
1263 return onepart ? valvar_pool : var_pool;
1266 /* Build a decl_or_value out of a decl. */
1267 static inline decl_or_value
1268 dv_from_decl (tree decl)
1270 decl_or_value dv;
1271 dv = decl;
1272 gcc_checking_assert (dv_is_decl_p (dv));
1273 return dv;
1276 /* Build a decl_or_value out of a value. */
1277 static inline decl_or_value
1278 dv_from_value (rtx value)
1280 decl_or_value dv;
1281 dv = value;
1282 gcc_checking_assert (dv_is_value_p (dv));
1283 return dv;
1286 /* Return a value or the decl of a debug_expr as a decl_or_value. */
1287 static inline decl_or_value
1288 dv_from_rtx (rtx x)
1290 decl_or_value dv;
1292 switch (GET_CODE (x))
1294 case DEBUG_EXPR:
1295 dv = dv_from_decl (DEBUG_EXPR_TREE_DECL (x));
1296 gcc_checking_assert (DECL_RTL_KNOWN_SET (DEBUG_EXPR_TREE_DECL (x)) == x);
1297 break;
1299 case VALUE:
1300 dv = dv_from_value (x);
1301 break;
1303 default:
1304 gcc_unreachable ();
1307 return dv;
1310 extern void debug_dv (decl_or_value dv);
1312 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
1313 debug_dv (decl_or_value dv)
1315 if (dv_is_value_p (dv))
1316 debug_rtx (dv_as_value (dv));
1317 else
1318 debug_generic_stmt (dv_as_decl (dv));
1321 typedef unsigned int dvuid;
1323 /* Return the uid of DV. */
1325 static inline dvuid
1326 dv_uid (decl_or_value dv)
1328 if (dv_is_value_p (dv))
1329 return CSELIB_VAL_PTR (dv_as_value (dv))->uid;
1330 else
1331 return DECL_UID (dv_as_decl (dv));
1334 /* Compute the hash from the uid. */
1336 static inline hashval_t
1337 dv_uid2hash (dvuid uid)
1339 return uid;
1342 /* The hash function for a mask table in a shared_htab chain. */
1344 static inline hashval_t
1345 dv_htab_hash (decl_or_value dv)
1347 return dv_uid2hash (dv_uid (dv));
1350 /* The hash function for variable_htab, computes the hash value
1351 from the declaration of variable X. */
1353 static hashval_t
1354 variable_htab_hash (const void *x)
1356 const_variable const v = (const_variable) x;
1358 return dv_htab_hash (v->dv);
1361 /* Compare the declaration of variable X with declaration Y. */
1363 static int
1364 variable_htab_eq (const void *x, const void *y)
1366 const_variable const v = (const_variable) x;
1367 decl_or_value dv = CONST_CAST2 (decl_or_value, const void *, y);
1369 return (dv_as_opaque (v->dv) == dv_as_opaque (dv));
1372 static void loc_exp_dep_clear (variable var);
1374 /* Free the element of VARIABLE_HTAB (its type is struct variable_def). */
1376 static void
1377 variable_htab_free (void *elem)
1379 int i;
1380 variable var = (variable) elem;
1381 location_chain node, next;
1383 gcc_checking_assert (var->refcount > 0);
1385 var->refcount--;
1386 if (var->refcount > 0)
1387 return;
1389 for (i = 0; i < var->n_var_parts; i++)
1391 for (node = var->var_part[i].loc_chain; node; node = next)
1393 next = node->next;
1394 pool_free (loc_chain_pool, node);
1396 var->var_part[i].loc_chain = NULL;
1398 if (var->onepart && VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var))
1400 loc_exp_dep_clear (var);
1401 if (VAR_LOC_DEP_LST (var))
1402 VAR_LOC_DEP_LST (var)->pprev = NULL;
1403 XDELETE (VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var));
1404 /* These may be reused across functions, so reset
1405 e.g. NO_LOC_P. */
1406 if (var->onepart == ONEPART_DEXPR)
1407 set_dv_changed (var->dv, true);
1409 pool_free (onepart_pool (var->onepart), var);
1412 /* Initialize the set (array) SET of attrs to empty lists. */
1414 static void
1415 init_attrs_list_set (attrs *set)
1417 int i;
1419 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
1420 set[i] = NULL;
1423 /* Make the list *LISTP empty. */
1425 static void
1426 attrs_list_clear (attrs *listp)
1428 attrs list, next;
1430 for (list = *listp; list; list = next)
1432 next = list->next;
1433 pool_free (attrs_pool, list);
1435 *listp = NULL;
1438 /* Return true if the pair of DECL and OFFSET is the member of the LIST. */
1440 static attrs
1441 attrs_list_member (attrs list, decl_or_value dv, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
1443 for (; list; list = list->next)
1444 if (dv_as_opaque (list->dv) == dv_as_opaque (dv) && list->offset == offset)
1445 return list;
1446 return NULL;
1449 /* Insert the triplet DECL, OFFSET, LOC to the list *LISTP. */
1451 static void
1452 attrs_list_insert (attrs *listp, decl_or_value dv,
1453 HOST_WIDE_INT offset, rtx loc)
1455 attrs list;
1457 list = (attrs) pool_alloc (attrs_pool);
1458 list->loc = loc;
1459 list->dv = dv;
1460 list->offset = offset;
1461 list->next = *listp;
1462 *listp = list;
1465 /* Copy all nodes from SRC and create a list *DSTP of the copies. */
1467 static void
1468 attrs_list_copy (attrs *dstp, attrs src)
1470 attrs n;
1472 attrs_list_clear (dstp);
1473 for (; src; src = src->next)
1475 n = (attrs) pool_alloc (attrs_pool);
1476 n->loc = src->loc;
1477 n->dv = src->dv;
1478 n->offset = src->offset;
1479 n->next = *dstp;
1480 *dstp = n;
1484 /* Add all nodes from SRC which are not in *DSTP to *DSTP. */
1486 static void
1487 attrs_list_union (attrs *dstp, attrs src)
1489 for (; src; src = src->next)
1491 if (!attrs_list_member (*dstp, src->dv, src->offset))
1492 attrs_list_insert (dstp, src->dv, src->offset, src->loc);
1496 /* Combine nodes that are not onepart nodes from SRC and SRC2 into
1497 *DSTP. */
1499 static void
1500 attrs_list_mpdv_union (attrs *dstp, attrs src, attrs src2)
1502 gcc_assert (!*dstp);
1503 for (; src; src = src->next)
1505 if (!dv_onepart_p (src->dv))
1506 attrs_list_insert (dstp, src->dv, src->offset, src->loc);
1508 for (src = src2; src; src = src->next)
1510 if (!dv_onepart_p (src->dv)
1511 && !attrs_list_member (*dstp, src->dv, src->offset))
1512 attrs_list_insert (dstp, src->dv, src->offset, src->loc);
1516 /* Shared hashtable support. */
1518 /* Return true if VARS is shared. */
1520 static inline bool
1521 shared_hash_shared (shared_hash vars)
1523 return vars->refcount > 1;
1526 /* Return the hash table for VARS. */
1528 static inline htab_t
1529 shared_hash_htab (shared_hash vars)
1531 return vars->htab;
1534 /* Return true if VAR is shared, or maybe because VARS is shared. */
1536 static inline bool
1537 shared_var_p (variable var, shared_hash vars)
1539 /* Don't count an entry in the changed_variables table as a duplicate. */
1540 return ((var->refcount > 1 + (int) var->in_changed_variables)
1541 || shared_hash_shared (vars));
1544 /* Copy variables into a new hash table. */
1546 static shared_hash
1547 shared_hash_unshare (shared_hash vars)
1549 shared_hash new_vars = (shared_hash) pool_alloc (shared_hash_pool);
1550 gcc_assert (vars->refcount > 1);
1551 new_vars->refcount = 1;
1552 new_vars->htab
1553 = htab_create (htab_elements (vars->htab) + 3, variable_htab_hash,
1554 variable_htab_eq, variable_htab_free);
1555 vars_copy (new_vars->htab, vars->htab);
1556 vars->refcount--;
1557 return new_vars;
1560 /* Increment reference counter on VARS and return it. */
1562 static inline shared_hash
1563 shared_hash_copy (shared_hash vars)
1565 vars->refcount++;
1566 return vars;
1569 /* Decrement reference counter and destroy hash table if not shared
1570 anymore. */
1572 static void
1573 shared_hash_destroy (shared_hash vars)
1575 gcc_checking_assert (vars->refcount > 0);
1576 if (--vars->refcount == 0)
1578 htab_delete (vars->htab);
1579 pool_free (shared_hash_pool, vars);
1583 /* Unshare *PVARS if shared and return slot for DV. If INS is
1584 INSERT, insert it if not already present. */
1586 static inline void **
1587 shared_hash_find_slot_unshare_1 (shared_hash *pvars, decl_or_value dv,
1588 hashval_t dvhash, enum insert_option ins)
1590 if (shared_hash_shared (*pvars))
1591 *pvars = shared_hash_unshare (*pvars);
1592 return htab_find_slot_with_hash (shared_hash_htab (*pvars), dv, dvhash, ins);
1595 static inline void **
1596 shared_hash_find_slot_unshare (shared_hash *pvars, decl_or_value dv,
1597 enum insert_option ins)
1599 return shared_hash_find_slot_unshare_1 (pvars, dv, dv_htab_hash (dv), ins);
1602 /* Return slot for DV, if it is already present in the hash table.
1603 If it is not present, insert it only VARS is not shared, otherwise
1604 return NULL. */
1606 static inline void **
1607 shared_hash_find_slot_1 (shared_hash vars, decl_or_value dv, hashval_t dvhash)
1609 return htab_find_slot_with_hash (shared_hash_htab (vars), dv, dvhash,
1610 shared_hash_shared (vars)
1611 ? NO_INSERT : INSERT);
1614 static inline void **
1615 shared_hash_find_slot (shared_hash vars, decl_or_value dv)
1617 return shared_hash_find_slot_1 (vars, dv, dv_htab_hash (dv));
1620 /* Return slot for DV only if it is already present in the hash table. */
1622 static inline void **
1623 shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert_1 (shared_hash vars, decl_or_value dv,
1624 hashval_t dvhash)
1626 return htab_find_slot_with_hash (shared_hash_htab (vars), dv, dvhash,
1627 NO_INSERT);
1630 static inline void **
1631 shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert (shared_hash vars, decl_or_value dv)
1633 return shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert_1 (vars, dv, dv_htab_hash (dv));
1636 /* Return variable for DV or NULL if not already present in the hash
1637 table. */
1639 static inline variable
1640 shared_hash_find_1 (shared_hash vars, decl_or_value dv, hashval_t dvhash)
1642 return (variable) htab_find_with_hash (shared_hash_htab (vars), dv, dvhash);
1645 static inline variable
1646 shared_hash_find (shared_hash vars, decl_or_value dv)
1648 return shared_hash_find_1 (vars, dv, dv_htab_hash (dv));
1651 /* Return true if TVAL is better than CVAL as a canonival value. We
1652 choose lowest-numbered VALUEs, using the RTX address as a
1653 tie-breaker. The idea is to arrange them into a star topology,
1654 such that all of them are at most one step away from the canonical
1655 value, and the canonical value has backlinks to all of them, in
1656 addition to all the actual locations. We don't enforce this
1657 topology throughout the entire dataflow analysis, though.
1660 static inline bool
1661 canon_value_cmp (rtx tval, rtx cval)
1663 return !cval
1664 || CSELIB_VAL_PTR (tval)->uid < CSELIB_VAL_PTR (cval)->uid;
1667 static bool dst_can_be_shared;
1669 /* Return a copy of a variable VAR and insert it to dataflow set SET. */
1671 static void **
1672 unshare_variable (dataflow_set *set, void **slot, variable var,
1673 enum var_init_status initialized)
1675 variable new_var;
1676 int i;
1678 new_var = (variable) pool_alloc (onepart_pool (var->onepart));
1679 new_var->dv = var->dv;
1680 new_var->refcount = 1;
1681 var->refcount--;
1682 new_var->n_var_parts = var->n_var_parts;
1683 new_var->onepart = var->onepart;
1684 new_var->in_changed_variables = false;
1686 if (! flag_var_tracking_uninit)
1687 initialized = VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED;
1689 for (i = 0; i < var->n_var_parts; i++)
1691 location_chain node;
1692 location_chain *nextp;
1694 if (i == 0 && var->onepart)
1696 /* One-part auxiliary data is only used while emitting
1697 notes, so propagate it to the new variable in the active
1698 dataflow set. If we're not emitting notes, this will be
1699 a no-op. */
1700 gcc_checking_assert (!VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var) || emit_notes);
1701 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (new_var) = VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var);
1702 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var) = NULL;
1704 else
1705 VAR_PART_OFFSET (new_var, i) = VAR_PART_OFFSET (var, i);
1706 nextp = &new_var->var_part[i].loc_chain;
1707 for (node = var->var_part[i].loc_chain; node; node = node->next)
1709 location_chain new_lc;
1711 new_lc = (location_chain) pool_alloc (loc_chain_pool);
1712 new_lc->next = NULL;
1713 if (node->init > initialized)
1714 new_lc->init = node->init;
1715 else
1716 new_lc->init = initialized;
1717 if (node->set_src && !(MEM_P (node->set_src)))
1718 new_lc->set_src = node->set_src;
1719 else
1720 new_lc->set_src = NULL;
1721 new_lc->loc = node->loc;
1723 *nextp = new_lc;
1724 nextp = &new_lc->next;
1727 new_var->var_part[i].cur_loc = var->var_part[i].cur_loc;
1730 dst_can_be_shared = false;
1731 if (shared_hash_shared (set->vars))
1732 slot = shared_hash_find_slot_unshare (&set->vars, var->dv, NO_INSERT);
1733 else if (set->traversed_vars && set->vars != set->traversed_vars)
1734 slot = shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert (set->vars, var->dv);
1735 *slot = new_var;
1736 if (var->in_changed_variables)
1738 void **cslot
1739 = htab_find_slot_with_hash (changed_variables, var->dv,
1740 dv_htab_hash (var->dv), NO_INSERT);
1741 gcc_assert (*cslot == (void *) var);
1742 var->in_changed_variables = false;
1743 variable_htab_free (var);
1744 *cslot = new_var;
1745 new_var->in_changed_variables = true;
1747 return slot;
1750 /* Copy all variables from hash table SRC to hash table DST. */
1752 static void
1753 vars_copy (htab_t dst, htab_t src)
1755 htab_iterator hi;
1756 variable var;
1758 FOR_EACH_HTAB_ELEMENT (src, var, variable, hi)
1760 void **dstp;
1761 var->refcount++;
1762 dstp = htab_find_slot_with_hash (dst, var->dv,
1763 dv_htab_hash (var->dv),
1764 INSERT);
1765 *dstp = var;
1769 /* Map a decl to its main debug decl. */
1771 static inline tree
1772 var_debug_decl (tree decl)
1774 if (decl && DECL_P (decl)
1775 && DECL_DEBUG_EXPR_IS_FROM (decl))
1777 tree debugdecl = DECL_DEBUG_EXPR (decl);
1778 if (debugdecl && DECL_P (debugdecl))
1779 decl = debugdecl;
1782 return decl;
1785 /* Set the register LOC to contain DV, OFFSET. */
1787 static void
1788 var_reg_decl_set (dataflow_set *set, rtx loc, enum var_init_status initialized,
1789 decl_or_value dv, HOST_WIDE_INT offset, rtx set_src,
1790 enum insert_option iopt)
1792 attrs node;
1793 bool decl_p = dv_is_decl_p (dv);
1795 if (decl_p)
1796 dv = dv_from_decl (var_debug_decl (dv_as_decl (dv)));
1798 for (node = set->regs[REGNO (loc)]; node; node = node->next)
1799 if (dv_as_opaque (node->dv) == dv_as_opaque (dv)
1800 && node->offset == offset)
1801 break;
1802 if (!node)
1803 attrs_list_insert (&set->regs[REGNO (loc)], dv, offset, loc);
1804 set_variable_part (set, loc, dv, offset, initialized, set_src, iopt);
1807 /* Set the register to contain REG_EXPR (LOC), REG_OFFSET (LOC). */
1809 static void
1810 var_reg_set (dataflow_set *set, rtx loc, enum var_init_status initialized,
1811 rtx set_src)
1813 tree decl = REG_EXPR (loc);
1814 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = REG_OFFSET (loc);
1816 var_reg_decl_set (set, loc, initialized,
1817 dv_from_decl (decl), offset, set_src, INSERT);
1820 static enum var_init_status
1821 get_init_value (dataflow_set *set, rtx loc, decl_or_value dv)
1823 variable var;
1824 int i;
1825 enum var_init_status ret_val = VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNKNOWN;
1827 if (! flag_var_tracking_uninit)
1828 return VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED;
1830 var = shared_hash_find (set->vars, dv);
1831 if (var)
1833 for (i = 0; i < var->n_var_parts && ret_val == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNKNOWN; i++)
1835 location_chain nextp;
1836 for (nextp = var->var_part[i].loc_chain; nextp; nextp = nextp->next)
1837 if (rtx_equal_p (nextp->loc, loc))
1839 ret_val = nextp->init;
1840 break;
1845 return ret_val;
1848 /* Delete current content of register LOC in dataflow set SET and set
1849 the register to contain REG_EXPR (LOC), REG_OFFSET (LOC). If
1850 MODIFY is true, any other live copies of the same variable part are
1851 also deleted from the dataflow set, otherwise the variable part is
1852 assumed to be copied from another location holding the same
1853 part. */
1855 static void
1856 var_reg_delete_and_set (dataflow_set *set, rtx loc, bool modify,
1857 enum var_init_status initialized, rtx set_src)
1859 tree decl = REG_EXPR (loc);
1860 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = REG_OFFSET (loc);
1861 attrs node, next;
1862 attrs *nextp;
1864 decl = var_debug_decl (decl);
1866 if (initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNKNOWN)
1867 initialized = get_init_value (set, loc, dv_from_decl (decl));
1869 nextp = &set->regs[REGNO (loc)];
1870 for (node = *nextp; node; node = next)
1872 next = node->next;
1873 if (dv_as_opaque (node->dv) != decl || node->offset != offset)
1875 delete_variable_part (set, node->loc, node->dv, node->offset);
1876 pool_free (attrs_pool, node);
1877 *nextp = next;
1879 else
1881 node->loc = loc;
1882 nextp = &node->next;
1885 if (modify)
1886 clobber_variable_part (set, loc, dv_from_decl (decl), offset, set_src);
1887 var_reg_set (set, loc, initialized, set_src);
1890 /* Delete the association of register LOC in dataflow set SET with any
1891 variables that aren't onepart. If CLOBBER is true, also delete any
1892 other live copies of the same variable part, and delete the
1893 association with onepart dvs too. */
1895 static void
1896 var_reg_delete (dataflow_set *set, rtx loc, bool clobber)
1898 attrs *nextp = &set->regs[REGNO (loc)];
1899 attrs node, next;
1901 if (clobber)
1903 tree decl = REG_EXPR (loc);
1904 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = REG_OFFSET (loc);
1906 decl = var_debug_decl (decl);
1908 clobber_variable_part (set, NULL, dv_from_decl (decl), offset, NULL);
1911 for (node = *nextp; node; node = next)
1913 next = node->next;
1914 if (clobber || !dv_onepart_p (node->dv))
1916 delete_variable_part (set, node->loc, node->dv, node->offset);
1917 pool_free (attrs_pool, node);
1918 *nextp = next;
1920 else
1921 nextp = &node->next;
1925 /* Delete content of register with number REGNO in dataflow set SET. */
1927 static void
1928 var_regno_delete (dataflow_set *set, int regno)
1930 attrs *reg = &set->regs[regno];
1931 attrs node, next;
1933 for (node = *reg; node; node = next)
1935 next = node->next;
1936 delete_variable_part (set, node->loc, node->dv, node->offset);
1937 pool_free (attrs_pool, node);
1939 *reg = NULL;
1942 /* Set the location of DV, OFFSET as the MEM LOC. */
1944 static void
1945 var_mem_decl_set (dataflow_set *set, rtx loc, enum var_init_status initialized,
1946 decl_or_value dv, HOST_WIDE_INT offset, rtx set_src,
1947 enum insert_option iopt)
1949 if (dv_is_decl_p (dv))
1950 dv = dv_from_decl (var_debug_decl (dv_as_decl (dv)));
1952 set_variable_part (set, loc, dv, offset, initialized, set_src, iopt);
1955 /* Set the location part of variable MEM_EXPR (LOC) in dataflow set
1956 SET to LOC.
1957 Adjust the address first if it is stack pointer based. */
1959 static void
1960 var_mem_set (dataflow_set *set, rtx loc, enum var_init_status initialized,
1961 rtx set_src)
1963 tree decl = MEM_EXPR (loc);
1964 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = INT_MEM_OFFSET (loc);
1966 var_mem_decl_set (set, loc, initialized,
1967 dv_from_decl (decl), offset, set_src, INSERT);
1970 /* Delete and set the location part of variable MEM_EXPR (LOC) in
1971 dataflow set SET to LOC. If MODIFY is true, any other live copies
1972 of the same variable part are also deleted from the dataflow set,
1973 otherwise the variable part is assumed to be copied from another
1974 location holding the same part.
1975 Adjust the address first if it is stack pointer based. */
1977 static void
1978 var_mem_delete_and_set (dataflow_set *set, rtx loc, bool modify,
1979 enum var_init_status initialized, rtx set_src)
1981 tree decl = MEM_EXPR (loc);
1982 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = INT_MEM_OFFSET (loc);
1984 decl = var_debug_decl (decl);
1986 if (initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNKNOWN)
1987 initialized = get_init_value (set, loc, dv_from_decl (decl));
1989 if (modify)
1990 clobber_variable_part (set, NULL, dv_from_decl (decl), offset, set_src);
1991 var_mem_set (set, loc, initialized, set_src);
1994 /* Delete the location part LOC from dataflow set SET. If CLOBBER is
1995 true, also delete any other live copies of the same variable part.
1996 Adjust the address first if it is stack pointer based. */
1998 static void
1999 var_mem_delete (dataflow_set *set, rtx loc, bool clobber)
2001 tree decl = MEM_EXPR (loc);
2002 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = INT_MEM_OFFSET (loc);
2004 decl = var_debug_decl (decl);
2005 if (clobber)
2006 clobber_variable_part (set, NULL, dv_from_decl (decl), offset, NULL);
2007 delete_variable_part (set, loc, dv_from_decl (decl), offset);
2010 /* Return true if LOC should not be expanded for location expressions,
2011 or used in them. */
2013 static inline bool
2014 unsuitable_loc (rtx loc)
2016 switch (GET_CODE (loc))
2018 case PC:
2019 case SCRATCH:
2020 case CC0:
2021 case ASM_INPUT:
2022 case ASM_OPERANDS:
2023 return true;
2025 default:
2026 return false;
2030 /* Bind a value to a location it was just stored in. If MODIFIED
2031 holds, assume the location was modified, detaching it from any
2032 values bound to it. */
2034 static void
2035 val_store (dataflow_set *set, rtx val, rtx loc, rtx insn, bool modified)
2037 cselib_val *v = CSELIB_VAL_PTR (val);
2039 gcc_assert (cselib_preserved_value_p (v));
2041 if (dump_file)
2043 fprintf (dump_file, "%i: ", insn ? INSN_UID (insn) : 0);
2044 print_inline_rtx (dump_file, loc, 0);
2045 fprintf (dump_file, " evaluates to ");
2046 print_inline_rtx (dump_file, val, 0);
2047 if (v->locs)
2049 struct elt_loc_list *l;
2050 for (l = v->locs; l; l = l->next)
2052 fprintf (dump_file, "\n%i: ", INSN_UID (l->setting_insn));
2053 print_inline_rtx (dump_file, l->loc, 0);
2056 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
2059 gcc_checking_assert (!unsuitable_loc (loc));
2061 if (REG_P (loc))
2063 if (modified)
2064 var_regno_delete (set, REGNO (loc));
2065 var_reg_decl_set (set, loc, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED,
2066 dv_from_value (val), 0, NULL_RTX, INSERT);
2068 else if (MEM_P (loc))
2069 var_mem_decl_set (set, loc, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED,
2070 dv_from_value (val), 0, NULL_RTX, INSERT);
2071 else
2072 /* ??? Ideally we wouldn't get these, and use them from the static
2073 cselib loc list. */
2074 set_variable_part (set, loc, dv_from_value (val), 0,
2075 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED, NULL_RTX, INSERT);
2078 /* Reset this node, detaching all its equivalences. Return the slot
2079 in the variable hash table that holds dv, if there is one. */
2081 static void
2082 val_reset (dataflow_set *set, decl_or_value dv)
2084 variable var = shared_hash_find (set->vars, dv) ;
2085 location_chain node;
2086 rtx cval;
2088 if (!var || !var->n_var_parts)
2089 return;
2091 gcc_assert (var->n_var_parts == 1);
2093 cval = NULL;
2094 for (node = var->var_part[0].loc_chain; node; node = node->next)
2095 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == VALUE
2096 && canon_value_cmp (node->loc, cval))
2097 cval = node->loc;
2099 for (node = var->var_part[0].loc_chain; node; node = node->next)
2100 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == VALUE && cval != node->loc)
2102 /* Redirect the equivalence link to the new canonical
2103 value, or simply remove it if it would point at
2104 itself. */
2105 if (cval)
2106 set_variable_part (set, cval, dv_from_value (node->loc),
2107 0, node->init, node->set_src, NO_INSERT);
2108 delete_variable_part (set, dv_as_value (dv),
2109 dv_from_value (node->loc), 0);
2112 if (cval)
2114 decl_or_value cdv = dv_from_value (cval);
2116 /* Keep the remaining values connected, accummulating links
2117 in the canonical value. */
2118 for (node = var->var_part[0].loc_chain; node; node = node->next)
2120 if (node->loc == cval)
2121 continue;
2122 else if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == REG)
2123 var_reg_decl_set (set, node->loc, node->init, cdv, 0,
2124 node->set_src, NO_INSERT);
2125 else if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == MEM)
2126 var_mem_decl_set (set, node->loc, node->init, cdv, 0,
2127 node->set_src, NO_INSERT);
2128 else
2129 set_variable_part (set, node->loc, cdv, 0,
2130 node->init, node->set_src, NO_INSERT);
2134 /* We remove this last, to make sure that the canonical value is not
2135 removed to the point of requiring reinsertion. */
2136 if (cval)
2137 delete_variable_part (set, dv_as_value (dv), dv_from_value (cval), 0);
2139 clobber_variable_part (set, NULL, dv, 0, NULL);
2142 /* Find the values in a given location and map the val to another
2143 value, if it is unique, or add the location as one holding the
2144 value. */
2146 static void
2147 val_resolve (dataflow_set *set, rtx val, rtx loc, rtx insn)
2149 decl_or_value dv = dv_from_value (val);
2151 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
2153 if (insn)
2154 fprintf (dump_file, "%i: ", INSN_UID (insn));
2155 else
2156 fprintf (dump_file, "head: ");
2157 print_inline_rtx (dump_file, val, 0);
2158 fputs (" is at ", dump_file);
2159 print_inline_rtx (dump_file, loc, 0);
2160 fputc ('\n', dump_file);
2163 val_reset (set, dv);
2165 gcc_checking_assert (!unsuitable_loc (loc));
2167 if (REG_P (loc))
2169 attrs node, found = NULL;
2171 for (node = set->regs[REGNO (loc)]; node; node = node->next)
2172 if (dv_is_value_p (node->dv)
2173 && GET_MODE (dv_as_value (node->dv)) == GET_MODE (loc))
2175 found = node;
2177 /* Map incoming equivalences. ??? Wouldn't it be nice if
2178 we just started sharing the location lists? Maybe a
2179 circular list ending at the value itself or some
2180 such. */
2181 set_variable_part (set, dv_as_value (node->dv),
2182 dv_from_value (val), node->offset,
2183 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED, NULL_RTX, INSERT);
2184 set_variable_part (set, val, node->dv, node->offset,
2185 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED, NULL_RTX, INSERT);
2188 /* If we didn't find any equivalence, we need to remember that
2189 this value is held in the named register. */
2190 if (!found)
2191 var_reg_decl_set (set, loc, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED,
2192 dv_from_value (val), 0, NULL_RTX, INSERT);
2194 else if (MEM_P (loc))
2195 /* ??? Merge equivalent MEMs. */
2196 var_mem_decl_set (set, loc, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED,
2197 dv_from_value (val), 0, NULL_RTX, INSERT);
2198 else
2199 /* ??? Ideally we wouldn't get these, and use them from the static
2200 cselib loc list. */
2201 /* ??? Merge equivalent expressions. */
2202 set_variable_part (set, loc, dv_from_value (val), 0,
2203 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED, NULL_RTX, INSERT);
2206 /* Initialize dataflow set SET to be empty.
2207 VARS_SIZE is the initial size of hash table VARS. */
2209 static void
2210 dataflow_set_init (dataflow_set *set)
2212 init_attrs_list_set (set->regs);
2213 set->vars = shared_hash_copy (empty_shared_hash);
2214 set->stack_adjust = 0;
2215 set->traversed_vars = NULL;
2218 /* Delete the contents of dataflow set SET. */
2220 static void
2221 dataflow_set_clear (dataflow_set *set)
2223 int i;
2225 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
2226 attrs_list_clear (&set->regs[i]);
2228 shared_hash_destroy (set->vars);
2229 set->vars = shared_hash_copy (empty_shared_hash);
2232 /* Copy the contents of dataflow set SRC to DST. */
2234 static void
2235 dataflow_set_copy (dataflow_set *dst, dataflow_set *src)
2237 int i;
2239 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
2240 attrs_list_copy (&dst->regs[i], src->regs[i]);
2242 shared_hash_destroy (dst->vars);
2243 dst->vars = shared_hash_copy (src->vars);
2244 dst->stack_adjust = src->stack_adjust;
2247 /* Information for merging lists of locations for a given offset of variable.
2249 struct variable_union_info
2251 /* Node of the location chain. */
2252 location_chain lc;
2254 /* The sum of positions in the input chains. */
2255 int pos;
2257 /* The position in the chain of DST dataflow set. */
2258 int pos_dst;
2261 /* Buffer for location list sorting and its allocated size. */
2262 static struct variable_union_info *vui_vec;
2263 static int vui_allocated;
2265 /* Compare function for qsort, order the structures by POS element. */
2267 static int
2268 variable_union_info_cmp_pos (const void *n1, const void *n2)
2270 const struct variable_union_info *const i1 =
2271 (const struct variable_union_info *) n1;
2272 const struct variable_union_info *const i2 =
2273 ( const struct variable_union_info *) n2;
2275 if (i1->pos != i2->pos)
2276 return i1->pos - i2->pos;
2278 return (i1->pos_dst - i2->pos_dst);
2281 /* Compute union of location parts of variable *SLOT and the same variable
2282 from hash table DATA. Compute "sorted" union of the location chains
2283 for common offsets, i.e. the locations of a variable part are sorted by
2284 a priority where the priority is the sum of the positions in the 2 chains
2285 (if a location is only in one list the position in the second list is
2286 defined to be larger than the length of the chains).
2287 When we are updating the location parts the newest location is in the
2288 beginning of the chain, so when we do the described "sorted" union
2289 we keep the newest locations in the beginning. */
2291 static int
2292 variable_union (variable src, dataflow_set *set)
2294 variable dst;
2295 void **dstp;
2296 int i, j, k;
2298 dstp = shared_hash_find_slot (set->vars, src->dv);
2299 if (!dstp || !*dstp)
2301 src->refcount++;
2303 dst_can_be_shared = false;
2304 if (!dstp)
2305 dstp = shared_hash_find_slot_unshare (&set->vars, src->dv, INSERT);
2307 *dstp = src;
2309 /* Continue traversing the hash table. */
2310 return 1;
2312 else
2313 dst = (variable) *dstp;
2315 gcc_assert (src->n_var_parts);
2316 gcc_checking_assert (src->onepart == dst->onepart);
2318 /* We can combine one-part variables very efficiently, because their
2319 entries are in canonical order. */
2320 if (src->onepart)
2322 location_chain *nodep, dnode, snode;
2324 gcc_assert (src->n_var_parts == 1
2325 && dst->n_var_parts == 1);
2327 snode = src->var_part[0].loc_chain;
2328 gcc_assert (snode);
2330 restart_onepart_unshared:
2331 nodep = &dst->var_part[0].loc_chain;
2332 dnode = *nodep;
2333 gcc_assert (dnode);
2335 while (snode)
2337 int r = dnode ? loc_cmp (dnode->loc, snode->loc) : 1;
2339 if (r > 0)
2341 location_chain nnode;
2343 if (shared_var_p (dst, set->vars))
2345 dstp = unshare_variable (set, dstp, dst,
2346 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
2347 dst = (variable)*dstp;
2348 goto restart_onepart_unshared;
2351 *nodep = nnode = (location_chain) pool_alloc (loc_chain_pool);
2352 nnode->loc = snode->loc;
2353 nnode->init = snode->init;
2354 if (!snode->set_src || MEM_P (snode->set_src))
2355 nnode->set_src = NULL;
2356 else
2357 nnode->set_src = snode->set_src;
2358 nnode->next = dnode;
2359 dnode = nnode;
2361 else if (r == 0)
2362 gcc_checking_assert (rtx_equal_p (dnode->loc, snode->loc));
2364 if (r >= 0)
2365 snode = snode->next;
2367 nodep = &dnode->next;
2368 dnode = *nodep;
2371 return 1;
2374 gcc_checking_assert (!src->onepart);
2376 /* Count the number of location parts, result is K. */
2377 for (i = 0, j = 0, k = 0;
2378 i < src->n_var_parts && j < dst->n_var_parts; k++)
2380 if (VAR_PART_OFFSET (src, i) == VAR_PART_OFFSET (dst, j))
2382 i++;
2383 j++;
2385 else if (VAR_PART_OFFSET (src, i) < VAR_PART_OFFSET (dst, j))
2386 i++;
2387 else
2388 j++;
2390 k += src->n_var_parts - i;
2391 k += dst->n_var_parts - j;
2393 /* We track only variables whose size is <= MAX_VAR_PARTS bytes
2394 thus there are at most MAX_VAR_PARTS different offsets. */
2395 gcc_checking_assert (dst->onepart ? k == 1 : k <= MAX_VAR_PARTS);
2397 if (dst->n_var_parts != k && shared_var_p (dst, set->vars))
2399 dstp = unshare_variable (set, dstp, dst, VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNKNOWN);
2400 dst = (variable)*dstp;
2403 i = src->n_var_parts - 1;
2404 j = dst->n_var_parts - 1;
2405 dst->n_var_parts = k;
2407 for (k--; k >= 0; k--)
2409 location_chain node, node2;
2411 if (i >= 0 && j >= 0
2412 && VAR_PART_OFFSET (src, i) == VAR_PART_OFFSET (dst, j))
2414 /* Compute the "sorted" union of the chains, i.e. the locations which
2415 are in both chains go first, they are sorted by the sum of
2416 positions in the chains. */
2417 int dst_l, src_l;
2418 int ii, jj, n;
2419 struct variable_union_info *vui;
2421 /* If DST is shared compare the location chains.
2422 If they are different we will modify the chain in DST with
2423 high probability so make a copy of DST. */
2424 if (shared_var_p (dst, set->vars))
2426 for (node = src->var_part[i].loc_chain,
2427 node2 = dst->var_part[j].loc_chain; node && node2;
2428 node = node->next, node2 = node2->next)
2430 if (!((REG_P (node2->loc)
2431 && REG_P (node->loc)
2432 && REGNO (node2->loc) == REGNO (node->loc))
2433 || rtx_equal_p (node2->loc, node->loc)))
2435 if (node2->init < node->init)
2436 node2->init = node->init;
2437 break;
2440 if (node || node2)
2442 dstp = unshare_variable (set, dstp, dst,
2443 VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNKNOWN);
2444 dst = (variable)*dstp;
2448 src_l = 0;
2449 for (node = src->var_part[i].loc_chain; node; node = node->next)
2450 src_l++;
2451 dst_l = 0;
2452 for (node = dst->var_part[j].loc_chain; node; node = node->next)
2453 dst_l++;
2455 if (dst_l == 1)
2457 /* The most common case, much simpler, no qsort is needed. */
2458 location_chain dstnode = dst->var_part[j].loc_chain;
2459 dst->var_part[k].loc_chain = dstnode;
2460 VAR_PART_OFFSET (dst, k) = VAR_PART_OFFSET(dst, j);
2461 node2 = dstnode;
2462 for (node = src->var_part[i].loc_chain; node; node = node->next)
2463 if (!((REG_P (dstnode->loc)
2464 && REG_P (node->loc)
2465 && REGNO (dstnode->loc) == REGNO (node->loc))
2466 || rtx_equal_p (dstnode->loc, node->loc)))
2468 location_chain new_node;
2470 /* Copy the location from SRC. */
2471 new_node = (location_chain) pool_alloc (loc_chain_pool);
2472 new_node->loc = node->loc;
2473 new_node->init = node->init;
2474 if (!node->set_src || MEM_P (node->set_src))
2475 new_node->set_src = NULL;
2476 else
2477 new_node->set_src = node->set_src;
2478 node2->next = new_node;
2479 node2 = new_node;
2481 node2->next = NULL;
2483 else
2485 if (src_l + dst_l > vui_allocated)
2487 vui_allocated = MAX (vui_allocated * 2, src_l + dst_l);
2488 vui_vec = XRESIZEVEC (struct variable_union_info, vui_vec,
2489 vui_allocated);
2491 vui = vui_vec;
2493 /* Fill in the locations from DST. */
2494 for (node = dst->var_part[j].loc_chain, jj = 0; node;
2495 node = node->next, jj++)
2497 vui[jj].lc = node;
2498 vui[jj].pos_dst = jj;
2500 /* Pos plus value larger than a sum of 2 valid positions. */
2501 vui[jj].pos = jj + src_l + dst_l;
2504 /* Fill in the locations from SRC. */
2505 n = dst_l;
2506 for (node = src->var_part[i].loc_chain, ii = 0; node;
2507 node = node->next, ii++)
2509 /* Find location from NODE. */
2510 for (jj = 0; jj < dst_l; jj++)
2512 if ((REG_P (vui[jj].lc->loc)
2513 && REG_P (node->loc)
2514 && REGNO (vui[jj].lc->loc) == REGNO (node->loc))
2515 || rtx_equal_p (vui[jj].lc->loc, node->loc))
2517 vui[jj].pos = jj + ii;
2518 break;
2521 if (jj >= dst_l) /* The location has not been found. */
2523 location_chain new_node;
2525 /* Copy the location from SRC. */
2526 new_node = (location_chain) pool_alloc (loc_chain_pool);
2527 new_node->loc = node->loc;
2528 new_node->init = node->init;
2529 if (!node->set_src || MEM_P (node->set_src))
2530 new_node->set_src = NULL;
2531 else
2532 new_node->set_src = node->set_src;
2533 vui[n].lc = new_node;
2534 vui[n].pos_dst = src_l + dst_l;
2535 vui[n].pos = ii + src_l + dst_l;
2536 n++;
2540 if (dst_l == 2)
2542 /* Special case still very common case. For dst_l == 2
2543 all entries dst_l ... n-1 are sorted, with for i >= dst_l
2544 vui[i].pos == i + src_l + dst_l. */
2545 if (vui[0].pos > vui[1].pos)
2547 /* Order should be 1, 0, 2... */
2548 dst->var_part[k].loc_chain = vui[1].lc;
2549 vui[1].lc->next = vui[0].lc;
2550 if (n >= 3)
2552 vui[0].lc->next = vui[2].lc;
2553 vui[n - 1].lc->next = NULL;
2555 else
2556 vui[0].lc->next = NULL;
2557 ii = 3;
2559 else
2561 dst->var_part[k].loc_chain = vui[0].lc;
2562 if (n >= 3 && vui[2].pos < vui[1].pos)
2564 /* Order should be 0, 2, 1, 3... */
2565 vui[0].lc->next = vui[2].lc;
2566 vui[2].lc->next = vui[1].lc;
2567 if (n >= 4)
2569 vui[1].lc->next = vui[3].lc;
2570 vui[n - 1].lc->next = NULL;
2572 else
2573 vui[1].lc->next = NULL;
2574 ii = 4;
2576 else
2578 /* Order should be 0, 1, 2... */
2579 ii = 1;
2580 vui[n - 1].lc->next = NULL;
2583 for (; ii < n; ii++)
2584 vui[ii - 1].lc->next = vui[ii].lc;
2586 else
2588 qsort (vui, n, sizeof (struct variable_union_info),
2589 variable_union_info_cmp_pos);
2591 /* Reconnect the nodes in sorted order. */
2592 for (ii = 1; ii < n; ii++)
2593 vui[ii - 1].lc->next = vui[ii].lc;
2594 vui[n - 1].lc->next = NULL;
2595 dst->var_part[k].loc_chain = vui[0].lc;
2598 VAR_PART_OFFSET (dst, k) = VAR_PART_OFFSET (dst, j);
2600 i--;
2601 j--;
2603 else if ((i >= 0 && j >= 0
2604 && VAR_PART_OFFSET (src, i) < VAR_PART_OFFSET (dst, j))
2605 || i < 0)
2607 dst->var_part[k] = dst->var_part[j];
2608 j--;
2610 else if ((i >= 0 && j >= 0
2611 && VAR_PART_OFFSET (src, i) > VAR_PART_OFFSET (dst, j))
2612 || j < 0)
2614 location_chain *nextp;
2616 /* Copy the chain from SRC. */
2617 nextp = &dst->var_part[k].loc_chain;
2618 for (node = src->var_part[i].loc_chain; node; node = node->next)
2620 location_chain new_lc;
2622 new_lc = (location_chain) pool_alloc (loc_chain_pool);
2623 new_lc->next = NULL;
2624 new_lc->init = node->init;
2625 if (!node->set_src || MEM_P (node->set_src))
2626 new_lc->set_src = NULL;
2627 else
2628 new_lc->set_src = node->set_src;
2629 new_lc->loc = node->loc;
2631 *nextp = new_lc;
2632 nextp = &new_lc->next;
2635 VAR_PART_OFFSET (dst, k) = VAR_PART_OFFSET (src, i);
2636 i--;
2638 dst->var_part[k].cur_loc = NULL;
2641 if (flag_var_tracking_uninit)
2642 for (i = 0; i < src->n_var_parts && i < dst->n_var_parts; i++)
2644 location_chain node, node2;
2645 for (node = src->var_part[i].loc_chain; node; node = node->next)
2646 for (node2 = dst->var_part[i].loc_chain; node2; node2 = node2->next)
2647 if (rtx_equal_p (node->loc, node2->loc))
2649 if (node->init > node2->init)
2650 node2->init = node->init;
2654 /* Continue traversing the hash table. */
2655 return 1;
2658 /* Compute union of dataflow sets SRC and DST and store it to DST. */
2660 static void
2661 dataflow_set_union (dataflow_set *dst, dataflow_set *src)
2663 int i;
2665 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
2666 attrs_list_union (&dst->regs[i], src->regs[i]);
2668 if (dst->vars == empty_shared_hash)
2670 shared_hash_destroy (dst->vars);
2671 dst->vars = shared_hash_copy (src->vars);
2673 else
2675 htab_iterator hi;
2676 variable var;
2678 FOR_EACH_HTAB_ELEMENT (shared_hash_htab (src->vars), var, variable, hi)
2679 variable_union (var, dst);
2683 /* Whether the value is currently being expanded. */
2684 #define VALUE_RECURSED_INTO(x) \
2685 (RTL_FLAG_CHECK2 ("VALUE_RECURSED_INTO", (x), VALUE, DEBUG_EXPR)->used)
2687 /* Whether no expansion was found, saving useless lookups.
2688 It must only be set when VALUE_CHANGED is clear. */
2689 #define NO_LOC_P(x) \
2690 (RTL_FLAG_CHECK2 ("NO_LOC_P", (x), VALUE, DEBUG_EXPR)->return_val)
2692 /* Whether cur_loc in the value needs to be (re)computed. */
2693 #define VALUE_CHANGED(x) \
2694 (RTL_FLAG_CHECK1 ("VALUE_CHANGED", (x), VALUE)->frame_related)
2695 /* Whether cur_loc in the decl needs to be (re)computed. */
2696 #define DECL_CHANGED(x) TREE_VISITED (x)
2698 /* Record (if NEWV) that DV needs to have its cur_loc recomputed. For
2699 user DECLs, this means they're in changed_variables. Values and
2700 debug exprs may be left with this flag set if no user variable
2701 requires them to be evaluated. */
2703 static inline void
2704 set_dv_changed (decl_or_value dv, bool newv)
2706 switch (dv_onepart_p (dv))
2708 case ONEPART_VALUE:
2709 if (newv)
2710 NO_LOC_P (dv_as_value (dv)) = false;
2711 VALUE_CHANGED (dv_as_value (dv)) = newv;
2712 break;
2714 case ONEPART_DEXPR:
2715 if (newv)
2716 NO_LOC_P (DECL_RTL_KNOWN_SET (dv_as_decl (dv))) = false;
2717 /* Fall through... */
2719 default:
2720 DECL_CHANGED (dv_as_decl (dv)) = newv;
2721 break;
2725 /* Return true if DV needs to have its cur_loc recomputed. */
2727 static inline bool
2728 dv_changed_p (decl_or_value dv)
2730 return (dv_is_value_p (dv)
2731 ? VALUE_CHANGED (dv_as_value (dv))
2732 : DECL_CHANGED (dv_as_decl (dv)));
2735 /* Return a location list node whose loc is rtx_equal to LOC, in the
2736 location list of a one-part variable or value VAR, or in that of
2737 any values recursively mentioned in the location lists. VARS must
2738 be in star-canonical form. */
2740 static location_chain
2741 find_loc_in_1pdv (rtx loc, variable var, htab_t vars)
2743 location_chain node;
2744 enum rtx_code loc_code;
2746 if (!var)
2747 return NULL;
2749 gcc_checking_assert (var->onepart);
2751 if (!var->n_var_parts)
2752 return NULL;
2754 gcc_checking_assert (loc != dv_as_opaque (var->dv));
2756 loc_code = GET_CODE (loc);
2757 for (node = var->var_part[0].loc_chain; node; node = node->next)
2759 decl_or_value dv;
2760 variable rvar;
2762 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) != loc_code)
2764 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) != VALUE)
2765 continue;
2767 else if (loc == node->loc)
2768 return node;
2769 else if (loc_code != VALUE)
2771 if (rtx_equal_p (loc, node->loc))
2772 return node;
2773 continue;
2776 /* Since we're in star-canonical form, we don't need to visit
2777 non-canonical nodes: one-part variables and non-canonical
2778 values would only point back to the canonical node. */
2779 if (dv_is_value_p (var->dv)
2780 && !canon_value_cmp (node->loc, dv_as_value (var->dv)))
2782 /* Skip all subsequent VALUEs. */
2783 while (node->next && GET_CODE (node->next->loc) == VALUE)
2785 node = node->next;
2786 gcc_checking_assert (!canon_value_cmp (node->loc,
2787 dv_as_value (var->dv)));
2788 if (loc == node->loc)
2789 return node;
2791 continue;
2794 gcc_checking_assert (node == var->var_part[0].loc_chain);
2795 gcc_checking_assert (!node->next);
2797 dv = dv_from_value (node->loc);
2798 rvar = (variable) htab_find_with_hash (vars, dv, dv_htab_hash (dv));
2799 return find_loc_in_1pdv (loc, rvar, vars);
2802 /* ??? Gotta look in cselib_val locations too. */
2804 return NULL;
2807 /* Hash table iteration argument passed to variable_merge. */
2808 struct dfset_merge
2810 /* The set in which the merge is to be inserted. */
2811 dataflow_set *dst;
2812 /* The set that we're iterating in. */
2813 dataflow_set *cur;
2814 /* The set that may contain the other dv we are to merge with. */
2815 dataflow_set *src;
2816 /* Number of onepart dvs in src. */
2817 int src_onepart_cnt;
2820 /* Insert LOC in *DNODE, if it's not there yet. The list must be in
2821 loc_cmp order, and it is maintained as such. */
2823 static void
2824 insert_into_intersection (location_chain *nodep, rtx loc,
2825 enum var_init_status status)
2827 location_chain node;
2828 int r;
2830 for (node = *nodep; node; nodep = &node->next, node = *nodep)
2831 if ((r = loc_cmp (node->loc, loc)) == 0)
2833 node->init = MIN (node->init, status);
2834 return;
2836 else if (r > 0)
2837 break;
2839 node = (location_chain) pool_alloc (loc_chain_pool);
2841 node->loc = loc;
2842 node->set_src = NULL;
2843 node->init = status;
2844 node->next = *nodep;
2845 *nodep = node;
2848 /* Insert in DEST the intersection of the locations present in both
2849 S1NODE and S2VAR, directly or indirectly. S1NODE is from a
2850 variable in DSM->cur, whereas S2VAR is from DSM->src. dvar is in
2851 DSM->dst. */
2853 static void
2854 intersect_loc_chains (rtx val, location_chain *dest, struct dfset_merge *dsm,
2855 location_chain s1node, variable s2var)
2857 dataflow_set *s1set = dsm->cur;
2858 dataflow_set *s2set = dsm->src;
2859 location_chain found;
2861 if (s2var)
2863 location_chain s2node;
2865 gcc_checking_assert (s2var->onepart);
2867 if (s2var->n_var_parts)
2869 s2node = s2var->var_part[0].loc_chain;
2871 for (; s1node && s2node;
2872 s1node = s1node->next, s2node = s2node->next)
2873 if (s1node->loc != s2node->loc)
2874 break;
2875 else if (s1node->loc == val)
2876 continue;
2877 else
2878 insert_into_intersection (dest, s1node->loc,
2879 MIN (s1node->init, s2node->init));
2883 for (; s1node; s1node = s1node->next)
2885 if (s1node->loc == val)
2886 continue;
2888 if ((found = find_loc_in_1pdv (s1node->loc, s2var,
2889 shared_hash_htab (s2set->vars))))
2891 insert_into_intersection (dest, s1node->loc,
2892 MIN (s1node->init, found->init));
2893 continue;
2896 if (GET_CODE (s1node->loc) == VALUE
2897 && !VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (s1node->loc))
2899 decl_or_value dv = dv_from_value (s1node->loc);
2900 variable svar = shared_hash_find (s1set->vars, dv);
2901 if (svar)
2903 if (svar->n_var_parts == 1)
2905 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (s1node->loc) = true;
2906 intersect_loc_chains (val, dest, dsm,
2907 svar->var_part[0].loc_chain,
2908 s2var);
2909 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (s1node->loc) = false;
2914 /* ??? gotta look in cselib_val locations too. */
2916 /* ??? if the location is equivalent to any location in src,
2917 searched recursively
2919 add to dst the values needed to represent the equivalence
2921 telling whether locations S is equivalent to another dv's
2922 location list:
2924 for each location D in the list
2926 if S and D satisfy rtx_equal_p, then it is present
2928 else if D is a value, recurse without cycles
2930 else if S and D have the same CODE and MODE
2932 for each operand oS and the corresponding oD
2934 if oS and oD are not equivalent, then S an D are not equivalent
2936 else if they are RTX vectors
2938 if any vector oS element is not equivalent to its respective oD,
2939 then S and D are not equivalent
2947 /* Return -1 if X should be before Y in a location list for a 1-part
2948 variable, 1 if Y should be before X, and 0 if they're equivalent
2949 and should not appear in the list. */
2951 static int
2952 loc_cmp (rtx x, rtx y)
2954 int i, j, r;
2955 RTX_CODE code = GET_CODE (x);
2956 const char *fmt;
2958 if (x == y)
2959 return 0;
2961 if (REG_P (x))
2963 if (!REG_P (y))
2964 return -1;
2965 gcc_assert (GET_MODE (x) == GET_MODE (y));
2966 if (REGNO (x) == REGNO (y))
2967 return 0;
2968 else if (REGNO (x) < REGNO (y))
2969 return -1;
2970 else
2971 return 1;
2974 if (REG_P (y))
2975 return 1;
2977 if (MEM_P (x))
2979 if (!MEM_P (y))
2980 return -1;
2981 gcc_assert (GET_MODE (x) == GET_MODE (y));
2982 return loc_cmp (XEXP (x, 0), XEXP (y, 0));
2985 if (MEM_P (y))
2986 return 1;
2988 if (GET_CODE (x) == VALUE)
2990 if (GET_CODE (y) != VALUE)
2991 return -1;
2992 /* Don't assert the modes are the same, that is true only
2993 when not recursing. (subreg:QI (value:SI 1:1) 0)
2994 and (subreg:QI (value:DI 2:2) 0) can be compared,
2995 even when the modes are different. */
2996 if (canon_value_cmp (x, y))
2997 return -1;
2998 else
2999 return 1;
3002 if (GET_CODE (y) == VALUE)
3003 return 1;
3005 /* Entry value is the least preferable kind of expression. */
3006 if (GET_CODE (x) == ENTRY_VALUE)
3008 if (GET_CODE (y) != ENTRY_VALUE)
3009 return 1;
3010 gcc_assert (GET_MODE (x) == GET_MODE (y));
3011 return loc_cmp (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (x), ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (y));
3014 if (GET_CODE (y) == ENTRY_VALUE)
3015 return -1;
3017 if (GET_CODE (x) == GET_CODE (y))
3018 /* Compare operands below. */;
3019 else if (GET_CODE (x) < GET_CODE (y))
3020 return -1;
3021 else
3022 return 1;
3024 gcc_assert (GET_MODE (x) == GET_MODE (y));
3026 if (GET_CODE (x) == DEBUG_EXPR)
3028 if (DEBUG_TEMP_UID (DEBUG_EXPR_TREE_DECL (x))
3029 < DEBUG_TEMP_UID (DEBUG_EXPR_TREE_DECL (y)))
3030 return -1;
3031 gcc_checking_assert (DEBUG_TEMP_UID (DEBUG_EXPR_TREE_DECL (x))
3032 > DEBUG_TEMP_UID (DEBUG_EXPR_TREE_DECL (y)));
3033 return 1;
3036 fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
3037 for (i = 0; i < GET_RTX_LENGTH (code); i++)
3038 switch (fmt[i])
3040 case 'w':
3041 if (XWINT (x, i) == XWINT (y, i))
3042 break;
3043 else if (XWINT (x, i) < XWINT (y, i))
3044 return -1;
3045 else
3046 return 1;
3048 case 'n':
3049 case 'i':
3050 if (XINT (x, i) == XINT (y, i))
3051 break;
3052 else if (XINT (x, i) < XINT (y, i))
3053 return -1;
3054 else
3055 return 1;
3057 case 'V':
3058 case 'E':
3059 /* Compare the vector length first. */
3060 if (XVECLEN (x, i) == XVECLEN (y, i))
3061 /* Compare the vectors elements. */;
3062 else if (XVECLEN (x, i) < XVECLEN (y, i))
3063 return -1;
3064 else
3065 return 1;
3067 for (j = 0; j < XVECLEN (x, i); j++)
3068 if ((r = loc_cmp (XVECEXP (x, i, j),
3069 XVECEXP (y, i, j))))
3070 return r;
3071 break;
3073 case 'e':
3074 if ((r = loc_cmp (XEXP (x, i), XEXP (y, i))))
3075 return r;
3076 break;
3078 case 'S':
3079 case 's':
3080 if (XSTR (x, i) == XSTR (y, i))
3081 break;
3082 if (!XSTR (x, i))
3083 return -1;
3084 if (!XSTR (y, i))
3085 return 1;
3086 if ((r = strcmp (XSTR (x, i), XSTR (y, i))) == 0)
3087 break;
3088 else if (r < 0)
3089 return -1;
3090 else
3091 return 1;
3093 case 'u':
3094 /* These are just backpointers, so they don't matter. */
3095 break;
3097 case '0':
3098 case 't':
3099 break;
3101 /* It is believed that rtx's at this level will never
3102 contain anything but integers and other rtx's,
3103 except for within LABEL_REFs and SYMBOL_REFs. */
3104 default:
3105 gcc_unreachable ();
3108 return 0;
3111 #if ENABLE_CHECKING
3112 /* Check the order of entries in one-part variables. */
3114 static int
3115 canonicalize_loc_order_check (void **slot, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3117 variable var = (variable) *slot;
3118 location_chain node, next;
3120 #ifdef ENABLE_RTL_CHECKING
3121 int i;
3122 for (i = 0; i < var->n_var_parts; i++)
3123 gcc_assert (var->var_part[0].cur_loc == NULL);
3124 gcc_assert (!var->in_changed_variables);
3125 #endif
3127 if (!var->onepart)
3128 return 1;
3130 gcc_assert (var->n_var_parts == 1);
3131 node = var->var_part[0].loc_chain;
3132 gcc_assert (node);
3134 while ((next = node->next))
3136 gcc_assert (loc_cmp (node->loc, next->loc) < 0);
3137 node = next;
3140 return 1;
3142 #endif
3144 /* Mark with VALUE_RECURSED_INTO values that have neighbors that are
3145 more likely to be chosen as canonical for an equivalence set.
3146 Ensure less likely values can reach more likely neighbors, making
3147 the connections bidirectional. */
3149 static int
3150 canonicalize_values_mark (void **slot, void *data)
3152 dataflow_set *set = (dataflow_set *)data;
3153 variable var = (variable) *slot;
3154 decl_or_value dv = var->dv;
3155 rtx val;
3156 location_chain node;
3158 if (!dv_is_value_p (dv))
3159 return 1;
3161 gcc_checking_assert (var->n_var_parts == 1);
3163 val = dv_as_value (dv);
3165 for (node = var->var_part[0].loc_chain; node; node = node->next)
3166 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == VALUE)
3168 if (canon_value_cmp (node->loc, val))
3169 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (val) = true;
3170 else
3172 decl_or_value odv = dv_from_value (node->loc);
3173 void **oslot = shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert (set->vars, odv);
3175 set_slot_part (set, val, oslot, odv, 0,
3176 node->init, NULL_RTX);
3178 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (node->loc) = true;
3182 return 1;
3185 /* Remove redundant entries from equivalence lists in onepart
3186 variables, canonicalizing equivalence sets into star shapes. */
3188 static int
3189 canonicalize_values_star (void **slot, void *data)
3191 dataflow_set *set = (dataflow_set *)data;
3192 variable var = (variable) *slot;
3193 decl_or_value dv = var->dv;
3194 location_chain node;
3195 decl_or_value cdv;
3196 rtx val, cval;
3197 void **cslot;
3198 bool has_value;
3199 bool has_marks;
3201 if (!var->onepart)
3202 return 1;
3204 gcc_checking_assert (var->n_var_parts == 1);
3206 if (dv_is_value_p (dv))
3208 cval = dv_as_value (dv);
3209 if (!VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (cval))
3210 return 1;
3211 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (cval) = false;
3213 else
3214 cval = NULL_RTX;
3216 restart:
3217 val = cval;
3218 has_value = false;
3219 has_marks = false;
3221 gcc_assert (var->n_var_parts == 1);
3223 for (node = var->var_part[0].loc_chain; node; node = node->next)
3224 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == VALUE)
3226 has_value = true;
3227 if (VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (node->loc))
3228 has_marks = true;
3229 if (canon_value_cmp (node->loc, cval))
3230 cval = node->loc;
3233 if (!has_value)
3234 return 1;
3236 if (cval == val)
3238 if (!has_marks || dv_is_decl_p (dv))
3239 return 1;
3241 /* Keep it marked so that we revisit it, either after visiting a
3242 child node, or after visiting a new parent that might be
3243 found out. */
3244 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (val) = true;
3246 for (node = var->var_part[0].loc_chain; node; node = node->next)
3247 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == VALUE
3248 && VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (node->loc))
3250 cval = node->loc;
3251 restart_with_cval:
3252 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (cval) = false;
3253 dv = dv_from_value (cval);
3254 slot = shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert (set->vars, dv);
3255 if (!slot)
3257 gcc_assert (dv_is_decl_p (var->dv));
3258 /* The canonical value was reset and dropped.
3259 Remove it. */
3260 clobber_variable_part (set, NULL, var->dv, 0, NULL);
3261 return 1;
3263 var = (variable)*slot;
3264 gcc_assert (dv_is_value_p (var->dv));
3265 if (var->n_var_parts == 0)
3266 return 1;
3267 gcc_assert (var->n_var_parts == 1);
3268 goto restart;
3271 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (val) = false;
3273 return 1;
3276 /* Push values to the canonical one. */
3277 cdv = dv_from_value (cval);
3278 cslot = shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert (set->vars, cdv);
3280 for (node = var->var_part[0].loc_chain; node; node = node->next)
3281 if (node->loc != cval)
3283 cslot = set_slot_part (set, node->loc, cslot, cdv, 0,
3284 node->init, NULL_RTX);
3285 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == VALUE)
3287 decl_or_value ndv = dv_from_value (node->loc);
3289 set_variable_part (set, cval, ndv, 0, node->init, NULL_RTX,
3290 NO_INSERT);
3292 if (canon_value_cmp (node->loc, val))
3294 /* If it could have been a local minimum, it's not any more,
3295 since it's now neighbor to cval, so it may have to push
3296 to it. Conversely, if it wouldn't have prevailed over
3297 val, then whatever mark it has is fine: if it was to
3298 push, it will now push to a more canonical node, but if
3299 it wasn't, then it has already pushed any values it might
3300 have to. */
3301 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (node->loc) = true;
3302 /* Make sure we visit node->loc by ensuring we cval is
3303 visited too. */
3304 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (cval) = true;
3306 else if (!VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (node->loc))
3307 /* If we have no need to "recurse" into this node, it's
3308 already "canonicalized", so drop the link to the old
3309 parent. */
3310 clobber_variable_part (set, cval, ndv, 0, NULL);
3312 else if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == REG)
3314 attrs list = set->regs[REGNO (node->loc)], *listp;
3316 /* Change an existing attribute referring to dv so that it
3317 refers to cdv, removing any duplicate this might
3318 introduce, and checking that no previous duplicates
3319 existed, all in a single pass. */
3321 while (list)
3323 if (list->offset == 0
3324 && (dv_as_opaque (list->dv) == dv_as_opaque (dv)
3325 || dv_as_opaque (list->dv) == dv_as_opaque (cdv)))
3326 break;
3328 list = list->next;
3331 gcc_assert (list);
3332 if (dv_as_opaque (list->dv) == dv_as_opaque (dv))
3334 list->dv = cdv;
3335 for (listp = &list->next; (list = *listp); listp = &list->next)
3337 if (list->offset)
3338 continue;
3340 if (dv_as_opaque (list->dv) == dv_as_opaque (cdv))
3342 *listp = list->next;
3343 pool_free (attrs_pool, list);
3344 list = *listp;
3345 break;
3348 gcc_assert (dv_as_opaque (list->dv) != dv_as_opaque (dv));
3351 else if (dv_as_opaque (list->dv) == dv_as_opaque (cdv))
3353 for (listp = &list->next; (list = *listp); listp = &list->next)
3355 if (list->offset)
3356 continue;
3358 if (dv_as_opaque (list->dv) == dv_as_opaque (dv))
3360 *listp = list->next;
3361 pool_free (attrs_pool, list);
3362 list = *listp;
3363 break;
3366 gcc_assert (dv_as_opaque (list->dv) != dv_as_opaque (cdv));
3369 else
3370 gcc_unreachable ();
3372 #if ENABLE_CHECKING
3373 while (list)
3375 if (list->offset == 0
3376 && (dv_as_opaque (list->dv) == dv_as_opaque (dv)
3377 || dv_as_opaque (list->dv) == dv_as_opaque (cdv)))
3378 gcc_unreachable ();
3380 list = list->next;
3382 #endif
3386 if (val)
3387 set_slot_part (set, val, cslot, cdv, 0,
3388 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED, NULL_RTX);
3390 slot = clobber_slot_part (set, cval, slot, 0, NULL);
3392 /* Variable may have been unshared. */
3393 var = (variable)*slot;
3394 gcc_checking_assert (var->n_var_parts && var->var_part[0].loc_chain->loc == cval
3395 && var->var_part[0].loc_chain->next == NULL);
3397 if (VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (cval))
3398 goto restart_with_cval;
3400 return 1;
3403 /* Bind one-part variables to the canonical value in an equivalence
3404 set. Not doing this causes dataflow convergence failure in rare
3405 circumstances, see PR42873. Unfortunately we can't do this
3406 efficiently as part of canonicalize_values_star, since we may not
3407 have determined or even seen the canonical value of a set when we
3408 get to a variable that references another member of the set. */
3410 static int
3411 canonicalize_vars_star (void **slot, void *data)
3413 dataflow_set *set = (dataflow_set *)data;
3414 variable var = (variable) *slot;
3415 decl_or_value dv = var->dv;
3416 location_chain node;
3417 rtx cval;
3418 decl_or_value cdv;
3419 void **cslot;
3420 variable cvar;
3421 location_chain cnode;
3423 if (!var->onepart || var->onepart == ONEPART_VALUE)
3424 return 1;
3426 gcc_assert (var->n_var_parts == 1);
3428 node = var->var_part[0].loc_chain;
3430 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) != VALUE)
3431 return 1;
3433 gcc_assert (!node->next);
3434 cval = node->loc;
3436 /* Push values to the canonical one. */
3437 cdv = dv_from_value (cval);
3438 cslot = shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert (set->vars, cdv);
3439 if (!cslot)
3440 return 1;
3441 cvar = (variable)*cslot;
3442 gcc_assert (cvar->n_var_parts == 1);
3444 cnode = cvar->var_part[0].loc_chain;
3446 /* CVAL is canonical if its value list contains non-VALUEs or VALUEs
3447 that are not “more canonical” than it. */
3448 if (GET_CODE (cnode->loc) != VALUE
3449 || !canon_value_cmp (cnode->loc, cval))
3450 return 1;
3452 /* CVAL was found to be non-canonical. Change the variable to point
3453 to the canonical VALUE. */
3454 gcc_assert (!cnode->next);
3455 cval = cnode->loc;
3457 slot = set_slot_part (set, cval, slot, dv, 0,
3458 node->init, node->set_src);
3459 clobber_slot_part (set, cval, slot, 0, node->set_src);
3461 return 1;
3464 /* Combine variable or value in *S1SLOT (in DSM->cur) with the
3465 corresponding entry in DSM->src. Multi-part variables are combined
3466 with variable_union, whereas onepart dvs are combined with
3467 intersection. */
3469 static int
3470 variable_merge_over_cur (variable s1var, struct dfset_merge *dsm)
3472 dataflow_set *dst = dsm->dst;
3473 void **dstslot;
3474 variable s2var, dvar = NULL;
3475 decl_or_value dv = s1var->dv;
3476 onepart_enum_t onepart = s1var->onepart;
3477 rtx val;
3478 hashval_t dvhash;
3479 location_chain node, *nodep;
3481 /* If the incoming onepart variable has an empty location list, then
3482 the intersection will be just as empty. For other variables,
3483 it's always union. */
3484 gcc_checking_assert (s1var->n_var_parts
3485 && s1var->var_part[0].loc_chain);
3487 if (!onepart)
3488 return variable_union (s1var, dst);
3490 gcc_checking_assert (s1var->n_var_parts == 1);
3492 dvhash = dv_htab_hash (dv);
3493 if (dv_is_value_p (dv))
3494 val = dv_as_value (dv);
3495 else
3496 val = NULL;
3498 s2var = shared_hash_find_1 (dsm->src->vars, dv, dvhash);
3499 if (!s2var)
3501 dst_can_be_shared = false;
3502 return 1;
3505 dsm->src_onepart_cnt--;
3506 gcc_assert (s2var->var_part[0].loc_chain
3507 && s2var->onepart == onepart
3508 && s2var->n_var_parts == 1);
3510 dstslot = shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert_1 (dst->vars, dv, dvhash);
3511 if (dstslot)
3513 dvar = (variable)*dstslot;
3514 gcc_assert (dvar->refcount == 1
3515 && dvar->onepart == onepart
3516 && dvar->n_var_parts == 1);
3517 nodep = &dvar->var_part[0].loc_chain;
3519 else
3521 nodep = &node;
3522 node = NULL;
3525 if (!dstslot && !onepart_variable_different_p (s1var, s2var))
3527 dstslot = shared_hash_find_slot_unshare_1 (&dst->vars, dv,
3528 dvhash, INSERT);
3529 *dstslot = dvar = s2var;
3530 dvar->refcount++;
3532 else
3534 dst_can_be_shared = false;
3536 intersect_loc_chains (val, nodep, dsm,
3537 s1var->var_part[0].loc_chain, s2var);
3539 if (!dstslot)
3541 if (node)
3543 dvar = (variable) pool_alloc (onepart_pool (onepart));
3544 dvar->dv = dv;
3545 dvar->refcount = 1;
3546 dvar->n_var_parts = 1;
3547 dvar->onepart = onepart;
3548 dvar->in_changed_variables = false;
3549 dvar->var_part[0].loc_chain = node;
3550 dvar->var_part[0].cur_loc = NULL;
3551 if (onepart)
3552 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (dvar) = NULL;
3553 else
3554 VAR_PART_OFFSET (dvar, 0) = 0;
3556 dstslot
3557 = shared_hash_find_slot_unshare_1 (&dst->vars, dv, dvhash,
3558 INSERT);
3559 gcc_assert (!*dstslot);
3560 *dstslot = dvar;
3562 else
3563 return 1;
3567 nodep = &dvar->var_part[0].loc_chain;
3568 while ((node = *nodep))
3570 location_chain *nextp = &node->next;
3572 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == REG)
3574 attrs list;
3576 for (list = dst->regs[REGNO (node->loc)]; list; list = list->next)
3577 if (GET_MODE (node->loc) == GET_MODE (list->loc)
3578 && dv_is_value_p (list->dv))
3579 break;
3581 if (!list)
3582 attrs_list_insert (&dst->regs[REGNO (node->loc)],
3583 dv, 0, node->loc);
3584 /* If this value became canonical for another value that had
3585 this register, we want to leave it alone. */
3586 else if (dv_as_value (list->dv) != val)
3588 dstslot = set_slot_part (dst, dv_as_value (list->dv),
3589 dstslot, dv, 0,
3590 node->init, NULL_RTX);
3591 dstslot = delete_slot_part (dst, node->loc, dstslot, 0);
3593 /* Since nextp points into the removed node, we can't
3594 use it. The pointer to the next node moved to nodep.
3595 However, if the variable we're walking is unshared
3596 during our walk, we'll keep walking the location list
3597 of the previously-shared variable, in which case the
3598 node won't have been removed, and we'll want to skip
3599 it. That's why we test *nodep here. */
3600 if (*nodep != node)
3601 nextp = nodep;
3604 else
3605 /* Canonicalization puts registers first, so we don't have to
3606 walk it all. */
3607 break;
3608 nodep = nextp;
3611 if (dvar != (variable)*dstslot)
3612 dvar = (variable)*dstslot;
3613 nodep = &dvar->var_part[0].loc_chain;
3615 if (val)
3617 /* Mark all referenced nodes for canonicalization, and make sure
3618 we have mutual equivalence links. */
3619 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (val) = true;
3620 for (node = *nodep; node; node = node->next)
3621 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == VALUE)
3623 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (node->loc) = true;
3624 set_variable_part (dst, val, dv_from_value (node->loc), 0,
3625 node->init, NULL, INSERT);
3628 dstslot = shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert_1 (dst->vars, dv, dvhash);
3629 gcc_assert (*dstslot == dvar);
3630 canonicalize_values_star (dstslot, dst);
3631 gcc_checking_assert (dstslot
3632 == shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert_1 (dst->vars,
3633 dv, dvhash));
3634 dvar = (variable)*dstslot;
3636 else
3638 bool has_value = false, has_other = false;
3640 /* If we have one value and anything else, we're going to
3641 canonicalize this, so make sure all values have an entry in
3642 the table and are marked for canonicalization. */
3643 for (node = *nodep; node; node = node->next)
3645 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == VALUE)
3647 /* If this was marked during register canonicalization,
3648 we know we have to canonicalize values. */
3649 if (has_value)
3650 has_other = true;
3651 has_value = true;
3652 if (has_other)
3653 break;
3655 else
3657 has_other = true;
3658 if (has_value)
3659 break;
3663 if (has_value && has_other)
3665 for (node = *nodep; node; node = node->next)
3667 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == VALUE)
3669 decl_or_value dv = dv_from_value (node->loc);
3670 void **slot = NULL;
3672 if (shared_hash_shared (dst->vars))
3673 slot = shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert (dst->vars, dv);
3674 if (!slot)
3675 slot = shared_hash_find_slot_unshare (&dst->vars, dv,
3676 INSERT);
3677 if (!*slot)
3679 variable var = (variable) pool_alloc (onepart_pool
3680 (ONEPART_VALUE));
3681 var->dv = dv;
3682 var->refcount = 1;
3683 var->n_var_parts = 1;
3684 var->onepart = ONEPART_VALUE;
3685 var->in_changed_variables = false;
3686 var->var_part[0].loc_chain = NULL;
3687 var->var_part[0].cur_loc = NULL;
3688 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var) = NULL;
3689 *slot = var;
3692 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (node->loc) = true;
3696 dstslot = shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert_1 (dst->vars, dv, dvhash);
3697 gcc_assert (*dstslot == dvar);
3698 canonicalize_values_star (dstslot, dst);
3699 gcc_checking_assert (dstslot
3700 == shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert_1 (dst->vars,
3701 dv, dvhash));
3702 dvar = (variable)*dstslot;
3706 if (!onepart_variable_different_p (dvar, s2var))
3708 variable_htab_free (dvar);
3709 *dstslot = dvar = s2var;
3710 dvar->refcount++;
3712 else if (s2var != s1var && !onepart_variable_different_p (dvar, s1var))
3714 variable_htab_free (dvar);
3715 *dstslot = dvar = s1var;
3716 dvar->refcount++;
3717 dst_can_be_shared = false;
3719 else
3720 dst_can_be_shared = false;
3722 return 1;
3725 /* Copy s2slot (in DSM->src) to DSM->dst if the variable is a
3726 multi-part variable. Unions of multi-part variables and
3727 intersections of one-part ones will be handled in
3728 variable_merge_over_cur(). */
3730 static int
3731 variable_merge_over_src (variable s2var, struct dfset_merge *dsm)
3733 dataflow_set *dst = dsm->dst;
3734 decl_or_value dv = s2var->dv;
3736 if (!s2var->onepart)
3738 void **dstp = shared_hash_find_slot (dst->vars, dv);
3739 *dstp = s2var;
3740 s2var->refcount++;
3741 return 1;
3744 dsm->src_onepart_cnt++;
3745 return 1;
3748 /* Combine dataflow set information from SRC2 into DST, using PDST
3749 to carry over information across passes. */
3751 static void
3752 dataflow_set_merge (dataflow_set *dst, dataflow_set *src2)
3754 dataflow_set cur = *dst;
3755 dataflow_set *src1 = &cur;
3756 struct dfset_merge dsm;
3757 int i;
3758 size_t src1_elems, src2_elems;
3759 htab_iterator hi;
3760 variable var;
3762 src1_elems = htab_elements (shared_hash_htab (src1->vars));
3763 src2_elems = htab_elements (shared_hash_htab (src2->vars));
3764 dataflow_set_init (dst);
3765 dst->stack_adjust = cur.stack_adjust;
3766 shared_hash_destroy (dst->vars);
3767 dst->vars = (shared_hash) pool_alloc (shared_hash_pool);
3768 dst->vars->refcount = 1;
3769 dst->vars->htab
3770 = htab_create (MAX (src1_elems, src2_elems), variable_htab_hash,
3771 variable_htab_eq, variable_htab_free);
3773 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
3774 attrs_list_mpdv_union (&dst->regs[i], src1->regs[i], src2->regs[i]);
3776 dsm.dst = dst;
3777 dsm.src = src2;
3778 dsm.cur = src1;
3779 dsm.src_onepart_cnt = 0;
3781 FOR_EACH_HTAB_ELEMENT (shared_hash_htab (dsm.src->vars), var, variable, hi)
3782 variable_merge_over_src (var, &dsm);
3783 FOR_EACH_HTAB_ELEMENT (shared_hash_htab (dsm.cur->vars), var, variable, hi)
3784 variable_merge_over_cur (var, &dsm);
3786 if (dsm.src_onepart_cnt)
3787 dst_can_be_shared = false;
3789 dataflow_set_destroy (src1);
3792 /* Mark register equivalences. */
3794 static void
3795 dataflow_set_equiv_regs (dataflow_set *set)
3797 int i;
3798 attrs list, *listp;
3800 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
3802 rtx canon[NUM_MACHINE_MODES];
3804 /* If the list is empty or one entry, no need to canonicalize
3805 anything. */
3806 if (set->regs[i] == NULL || set->regs[i]->next == NULL)
3807 continue;
3809 memset (canon, 0, sizeof (canon));
3811 for (list = set->regs[i]; list; list = list->next)
3812 if (list->offset == 0 && dv_is_value_p (list->dv))
3814 rtx val = dv_as_value (list->dv);
3815 rtx *cvalp = &canon[(int)GET_MODE (val)];
3816 rtx cval = *cvalp;
3818 if (canon_value_cmp (val, cval))
3819 *cvalp = val;
3822 for (list = set->regs[i]; list; list = list->next)
3823 if (list->offset == 0 && dv_onepart_p (list->dv))
3825 rtx cval = canon[(int)GET_MODE (list->loc)];
3827 if (!cval)
3828 continue;
3830 if (dv_is_value_p (list->dv))
3832 rtx val = dv_as_value (list->dv);
3834 if (val == cval)
3835 continue;
3837 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (val) = true;
3838 set_variable_part (set, val, dv_from_value (cval), 0,
3839 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED,
3840 NULL, NO_INSERT);
3843 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (cval) = true;
3844 set_variable_part (set, cval, list->dv, 0,
3845 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED, NULL, NO_INSERT);
3848 for (listp = &set->regs[i]; (list = *listp);
3849 listp = list ? &list->next : listp)
3850 if (list->offset == 0 && dv_onepart_p (list->dv))
3852 rtx cval = canon[(int)GET_MODE (list->loc)];
3853 void **slot;
3855 if (!cval)
3856 continue;
3858 if (dv_is_value_p (list->dv))
3860 rtx val = dv_as_value (list->dv);
3861 if (!VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (val))
3862 continue;
3865 slot = shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert (set->vars, list->dv);
3866 canonicalize_values_star (slot, set);
3867 if (*listp != list)
3868 list = NULL;
3873 /* Remove any redundant values in the location list of VAR, which must
3874 be unshared and 1-part. */
3876 static void
3877 remove_duplicate_values (variable var)
3879 location_chain node, *nodep;
3881 gcc_assert (var->onepart);
3882 gcc_assert (var->n_var_parts == 1);
3883 gcc_assert (var->refcount == 1);
3885 for (nodep = &var->var_part[0].loc_chain; (node = *nodep); )
3887 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == VALUE)
3889 if (VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (node->loc))
3891 /* Remove duplicate value node. */
3892 *nodep = node->next;
3893 pool_free (loc_chain_pool, node);
3894 continue;
3896 else
3897 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (node->loc) = true;
3899 nodep = &node->next;
3902 for (node = var->var_part[0].loc_chain; node; node = node->next)
3903 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == VALUE)
3905 gcc_assert (VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (node->loc));
3906 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (node->loc) = false;
3911 /* Hash table iteration argument passed to variable_post_merge. */
3912 struct dfset_post_merge
3914 /* The new input set for the current block. */
3915 dataflow_set *set;
3916 /* Pointer to the permanent input set for the current block, or
3917 NULL. */
3918 dataflow_set **permp;
3921 /* Create values for incoming expressions associated with one-part
3922 variables that don't have value numbers for them. */
3924 static int
3925 variable_post_merge_new_vals (void **slot, void *info)
3927 struct dfset_post_merge *dfpm = (struct dfset_post_merge *)info;
3928 dataflow_set *set = dfpm->set;
3929 variable var = (variable)*slot;
3930 location_chain node;
3932 if (!var->onepart || !var->n_var_parts)
3933 return 1;
3935 gcc_assert (var->n_var_parts == 1);
3937 if (dv_is_decl_p (var->dv))
3939 bool check_dupes = false;
3941 restart:
3942 for (node = var->var_part[0].loc_chain; node; node = node->next)
3944 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == VALUE)
3945 gcc_assert (!VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (node->loc));
3946 else if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == REG)
3948 attrs att, *attp, *curp = NULL;
3950 if (var->refcount != 1)
3952 slot = unshare_variable (set, slot, var,
3953 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
3954 var = (variable)*slot;
3955 goto restart;
3958 for (attp = &set->regs[REGNO (node->loc)]; (att = *attp);
3959 attp = &att->next)
3960 if (att->offset == 0
3961 && GET_MODE (att->loc) == GET_MODE (node->loc))
3963 if (dv_is_value_p (att->dv))
3965 rtx cval = dv_as_value (att->dv);
3966 node->loc = cval;
3967 check_dupes = true;
3968 break;
3970 else if (dv_as_opaque (att->dv) == dv_as_opaque (var->dv))
3971 curp = attp;
3974 if (!curp)
3976 curp = attp;
3977 while (*curp)
3978 if ((*curp)->offset == 0
3979 && GET_MODE ((*curp)->loc) == GET_MODE (node->loc)
3980 && dv_as_opaque ((*curp)->dv) == dv_as_opaque (var->dv))
3981 break;
3982 else
3983 curp = &(*curp)->next;
3984 gcc_assert (*curp);
3987 if (!att)
3989 decl_or_value cdv;
3990 rtx cval;
3992 if (!*dfpm->permp)
3994 *dfpm->permp = XNEW (dataflow_set);
3995 dataflow_set_init (*dfpm->permp);
3998 for (att = (*dfpm->permp)->regs[REGNO (node->loc)];
3999 att; att = att->next)
4000 if (GET_MODE (att->loc) == GET_MODE (node->loc))
4002 gcc_assert (att->offset == 0
4003 && dv_is_value_p (att->dv));
4004 val_reset (set, att->dv);
4005 break;
4008 if (att)
4010 cdv = att->dv;
4011 cval = dv_as_value (cdv);
4013 else
4015 /* Create a unique value to hold this register,
4016 that ought to be found and reused in
4017 subsequent rounds. */
4018 cselib_val *v;
4019 gcc_assert (!cselib_lookup (node->loc,
4020 GET_MODE (node->loc), 0,
4021 VOIDmode));
4022 v = cselib_lookup (node->loc, GET_MODE (node->loc), 1,
4023 VOIDmode);
4024 cselib_preserve_value (v);
4025 cselib_invalidate_rtx (node->loc);
4026 cval = v->val_rtx;
4027 cdv = dv_from_value (cval);
4028 if (dump_file)
4029 fprintf (dump_file,
4030 "Created new value %u:%u for reg %i\n",
4031 v->uid, v->hash, REGNO (node->loc));
4034 var_reg_decl_set (*dfpm->permp, node->loc,
4035 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED,
4036 cdv, 0, NULL, INSERT);
4038 node->loc = cval;
4039 check_dupes = true;
4042 /* Remove attribute referring to the decl, which now
4043 uses the value for the register, already existing or
4044 to be added when we bring perm in. */
4045 att = *curp;
4046 *curp = att->next;
4047 pool_free (attrs_pool, att);
4051 if (check_dupes)
4052 remove_duplicate_values (var);
4055 return 1;
4058 /* Reset values in the permanent set that are not associated with the
4059 chosen expression. */
4061 static int
4062 variable_post_merge_perm_vals (void **pslot, void *info)
4064 struct dfset_post_merge *dfpm = (struct dfset_post_merge *)info;
4065 dataflow_set *set = dfpm->set;
4066 variable pvar = (variable)*pslot, var;
4067 location_chain pnode;
4068 decl_or_value dv;
4069 attrs att;
4071 gcc_assert (dv_is_value_p (pvar->dv)
4072 && pvar->n_var_parts == 1);
4073 pnode = pvar->var_part[0].loc_chain;
4074 gcc_assert (pnode
4075 && !pnode->next
4076 && REG_P (pnode->loc));
4078 dv = pvar->dv;
4080 var = shared_hash_find (set->vars, dv);
4081 if (var)
4083 /* Although variable_post_merge_new_vals may have made decls
4084 non-star-canonical, values that pre-existed in canonical form
4085 remain canonical, and newly-created values reference a single
4086 REG, so they are canonical as well. Since VAR has the
4087 location list for a VALUE, using find_loc_in_1pdv for it is
4088 fine, since VALUEs don't map back to DECLs. */
4089 if (find_loc_in_1pdv (pnode->loc, var, shared_hash_htab (set->vars)))
4090 return 1;
4091 val_reset (set, dv);
4094 for (att = set->regs[REGNO (pnode->loc)]; att; att = att->next)
4095 if (att->offset == 0
4096 && GET_MODE (att->loc) == GET_MODE (pnode->loc)
4097 && dv_is_value_p (att->dv))
4098 break;
4100 /* If there is a value associated with this register already, create
4101 an equivalence. */
4102 if (att && dv_as_value (att->dv) != dv_as_value (dv))
4104 rtx cval = dv_as_value (att->dv);
4105 set_variable_part (set, cval, dv, 0, pnode->init, NULL, INSERT);
4106 set_variable_part (set, dv_as_value (dv), att->dv, 0, pnode->init,
4107 NULL, INSERT);
4109 else if (!att)
4111 attrs_list_insert (&set->regs[REGNO (pnode->loc)],
4112 dv, 0, pnode->loc);
4113 variable_union (pvar, set);
4116 return 1;
4119 /* Just checking stuff and registering register attributes for
4120 now. */
4122 static void
4123 dataflow_post_merge_adjust (dataflow_set *set, dataflow_set **permp)
4125 struct dfset_post_merge dfpm;
4127 dfpm.set = set;
4128 dfpm.permp = permp;
4130 htab_traverse (shared_hash_htab (set->vars), variable_post_merge_new_vals,
4131 &dfpm);
4132 if (*permp)
4133 htab_traverse (shared_hash_htab ((*permp)->vars),
4134 variable_post_merge_perm_vals, &dfpm);
4135 htab_traverse (shared_hash_htab (set->vars), canonicalize_values_star, set);
4136 htab_traverse (shared_hash_htab (set->vars), canonicalize_vars_star, set);
4139 /* Return a node whose loc is a MEM that refers to EXPR in the
4140 location list of a one-part variable or value VAR, or in that of
4141 any values recursively mentioned in the location lists. */
4143 static location_chain
4144 find_mem_expr_in_1pdv (tree expr, rtx val, htab_t vars)
4146 location_chain node;
4147 decl_or_value dv;
4148 variable var;
4149 location_chain where = NULL;
4151 if (!val)
4152 return NULL;
4154 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (val) == VALUE
4155 && !VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (val));
4157 dv = dv_from_value (val);
4158 var = (variable) htab_find_with_hash (vars, dv, dv_htab_hash (dv));
4160 if (!var)
4161 return NULL;
4163 gcc_assert (var->onepart);
4165 if (!var->n_var_parts)
4166 return NULL;
4168 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (val) = true;
4170 for (node = var->var_part[0].loc_chain; node; node = node->next)
4171 if (MEM_P (node->loc)
4172 && MEM_EXPR (node->loc) == expr
4173 && INT_MEM_OFFSET (node->loc) == 0)
4175 where = node;
4176 break;
4178 else if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == VALUE
4179 && !VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (node->loc)
4180 && (where = find_mem_expr_in_1pdv (expr, node->loc, vars)))
4181 break;
4183 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (val) = false;
4185 return where;
4188 /* Return TRUE if the value of MEM may vary across a call. */
4190 static bool
4191 mem_dies_at_call (rtx mem)
4193 tree expr = MEM_EXPR (mem);
4194 tree decl;
4196 if (!expr)
4197 return true;
4199 decl = get_base_address (expr);
4201 if (!decl)
4202 return true;
4204 if (!DECL_P (decl))
4205 return true;
4207 return (may_be_aliased (decl)
4208 || (!TREE_READONLY (decl) && is_global_var (decl)));
4211 /* Remove all MEMs from the location list of a hash table entry for a
4212 one-part variable, except those whose MEM attributes map back to
4213 the variable itself, directly or within a VALUE. */
4215 static int
4216 dataflow_set_preserve_mem_locs (void **slot, void *data)
4218 dataflow_set *set = (dataflow_set *) data;
4219 variable var = (variable) *slot;
4221 if (var->onepart == ONEPART_VDECL || var->onepart == ONEPART_DEXPR)
4223 tree decl = dv_as_decl (var->dv);
4224 location_chain loc, *locp;
4225 bool changed = false;
4227 if (!var->n_var_parts)
4228 return 1;
4230 gcc_assert (var->n_var_parts == 1);
4232 if (shared_var_p (var, set->vars))
4234 for (loc = var->var_part[0].loc_chain; loc; loc = loc->next)
4236 /* We want to remove dying MEMs that doesn't refer to DECL. */
4237 if (GET_CODE (loc->loc) == MEM
4238 && (MEM_EXPR (loc->loc) != decl
4239 || INT_MEM_OFFSET (loc->loc) != 0)
4240 && !mem_dies_at_call (loc->loc))
4241 break;
4242 /* We want to move here MEMs that do refer to DECL. */
4243 else if (GET_CODE (loc->loc) == VALUE
4244 && find_mem_expr_in_1pdv (decl, loc->loc,
4245 shared_hash_htab (set->vars)))
4246 break;
4249 if (!loc)
4250 return 1;
4252 slot = unshare_variable (set, slot, var, VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNKNOWN);
4253 var = (variable)*slot;
4254 gcc_assert (var->n_var_parts == 1);
4257 for (locp = &var->var_part[0].loc_chain, loc = *locp;
4258 loc; loc = *locp)
4260 rtx old_loc = loc->loc;
4261 if (GET_CODE (old_loc) == VALUE)
4263 location_chain mem_node
4264 = find_mem_expr_in_1pdv (decl, loc->loc,
4265 shared_hash_htab (set->vars));
4267 /* ??? This picks up only one out of multiple MEMs that
4268 refer to the same variable. Do we ever need to be
4269 concerned about dealing with more than one, or, given
4270 that they should all map to the same variable
4271 location, their addresses will have been merged and
4272 they will be regarded as equivalent? */
4273 if (mem_node)
4275 loc->loc = mem_node->loc;
4276 loc->set_src = mem_node->set_src;
4277 loc->init = MIN (loc->init, mem_node->init);
4281 if (GET_CODE (loc->loc) != MEM
4282 || (MEM_EXPR (loc->loc) == decl
4283 && INT_MEM_OFFSET (loc->loc) == 0)
4284 || !mem_dies_at_call (loc->loc))
4286 if (old_loc != loc->loc && emit_notes)
4288 if (old_loc == var->var_part[0].cur_loc)
4290 changed = true;
4291 var->var_part[0].cur_loc = NULL;
4294 locp = &loc->next;
4295 continue;
4298 if (emit_notes)
4300 if (old_loc == var->var_part[0].cur_loc)
4302 changed = true;
4303 var->var_part[0].cur_loc = NULL;
4306 *locp = loc->next;
4307 pool_free (loc_chain_pool, loc);
4310 if (!var->var_part[0].loc_chain)
4312 var->n_var_parts--;
4313 changed = true;
4315 if (changed)
4316 variable_was_changed (var, set);
4319 return 1;
4322 /* Remove all MEMs from the location list of a hash table entry for a
4323 value. */
4325 static int
4326 dataflow_set_remove_mem_locs (void **slot, void *data)
4328 dataflow_set *set = (dataflow_set *) data;
4329 variable var = (variable) *slot;
4331 if (var->onepart == ONEPART_VALUE)
4333 location_chain loc, *locp;
4334 bool changed = false;
4335 rtx cur_loc;
4337 gcc_assert (var->n_var_parts == 1);
4339 if (shared_var_p (var, set->vars))
4341 for (loc = var->var_part[0].loc_chain; loc; loc = loc->next)
4342 if (GET_CODE (loc->loc) == MEM
4343 && mem_dies_at_call (loc->loc))
4344 break;
4346 if (!loc)
4347 return 1;
4349 slot = unshare_variable (set, slot, var, VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNKNOWN);
4350 var = (variable)*slot;
4351 gcc_assert (var->n_var_parts == 1);
4354 if (VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var))
4355 cur_loc = VAR_LOC_FROM (var);
4356 else
4357 cur_loc = var->var_part[0].cur_loc;
4359 for (locp = &var->var_part[0].loc_chain, loc = *locp;
4360 loc; loc = *locp)
4362 if (GET_CODE (loc->loc) != MEM
4363 || !mem_dies_at_call (loc->loc))
4365 locp = &loc->next;
4366 continue;
4369 *locp = loc->next;
4370 /* If we have deleted the location which was last emitted
4371 we have to emit new location so add the variable to set
4372 of changed variables. */
4373 if (cur_loc == loc->loc)
4375 changed = true;
4376 var->var_part[0].cur_loc = NULL;
4377 if (VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var))
4378 VAR_LOC_FROM (var) = NULL;
4380 pool_free (loc_chain_pool, loc);
4383 if (!var->var_part[0].loc_chain)
4385 var->n_var_parts--;
4386 changed = true;
4388 if (changed)
4389 variable_was_changed (var, set);
4392 return 1;
4395 /* Remove all variable-location information about call-clobbered
4396 registers, as well as associations between MEMs and VALUEs. */
4398 static void
4399 dataflow_set_clear_at_call (dataflow_set *set)
4401 int r;
4403 for (r = 0; r < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; r++)
4404 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (regs_invalidated_by_call, r))
4405 var_regno_delete (set, r);
4407 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_INSNS)
4409 set->traversed_vars = set->vars;
4410 htab_traverse (shared_hash_htab (set->vars),
4411 dataflow_set_preserve_mem_locs, set);
4412 set->traversed_vars = set->vars;
4413 htab_traverse (shared_hash_htab (set->vars), dataflow_set_remove_mem_locs,
4414 set);
4415 set->traversed_vars = NULL;
4419 static bool
4420 variable_part_different_p (variable_part *vp1, variable_part *vp2)
4422 location_chain lc1, lc2;
4424 for (lc1 = vp1->loc_chain; lc1; lc1 = lc1->next)
4426 for (lc2 = vp2->loc_chain; lc2; lc2 = lc2->next)
4428 if (REG_P (lc1->loc) && REG_P (lc2->loc))
4430 if (REGNO (lc1->loc) == REGNO (lc2->loc))
4431 break;
4433 if (rtx_equal_p (lc1->loc, lc2->loc))
4434 break;
4436 if (!lc2)
4437 return true;
4439 return false;
4442 /* Return true if one-part variables VAR1 and VAR2 are different.
4443 They must be in canonical order. */
4445 static bool
4446 onepart_variable_different_p (variable var1, variable var2)
4448 location_chain lc1, lc2;
4450 if (var1 == var2)
4451 return false;
4453 gcc_assert (var1->n_var_parts == 1
4454 && var2->n_var_parts == 1);
4456 lc1 = var1->var_part[0].loc_chain;
4457 lc2 = var2->var_part[0].loc_chain;
4459 gcc_assert (lc1 && lc2);
4461 while (lc1 && lc2)
4463 if (loc_cmp (lc1->loc, lc2->loc))
4464 return true;
4465 lc1 = lc1->next;
4466 lc2 = lc2->next;
4469 return lc1 != lc2;
4472 /* Return true if variables VAR1 and VAR2 are different. */
4474 static bool
4475 variable_different_p (variable var1, variable var2)
4477 int i;
4479 if (var1 == var2)
4480 return false;
4482 if (var1->onepart != var2->onepart)
4483 return true;
4485 if (var1->n_var_parts != var2->n_var_parts)
4486 return true;
4488 if (var1->onepart && var1->n_var_parts)
4490 gcc_checking_assert (dv_as_opaque (var1->dv) == dv_as_opaque (var2->dv)
4491 && var1->n_var_parts == 1);
4492 /* One-part values have locations in a canonical order. */
4493 return onepart_variable_different_p (var1, var2);
4496 for (i = 0; i < var1->n_var_parts; i++)
4498 if (VAR_PART_OFFSET (var1, i) != VAR_PART_OFFSET (var2, i))
4499 return true;
4500 if (variable_part_different_p (&var1->var_part[i], &var2->var_part[i]))
4501 return true;
4502 if (variable_part_different_p (&var2->var_part[i], &var1->var_part[i]))
4503 return true;
4505 return false;
4508 /* Return true if dataflow sets OLD_SET and NEW_SET differ. */
4510 static bool
4511 dataflow_set_different (dataflow_set *old_set, dataflow_set *new_set)
4513 htab_iterator hi;
4514 variable var1;
4516 if (old_set->vars == new_set->vars)
4517 return false;
4519 if (htab_elements (shared_hash_htab (old_set->vars))
4520 != htab_elements (shared_hash_htab (new_set->vars)))
4521 return true;
4523 FOR_EACH_HTAB_ELEMENT (shared_hash_htab (old_set->vars), var1, variable, hi)
4525 htab_t htab = shared_hash_htab (new_set->vars);
4526 variable var2 = (variable) htab_find_with_hash (htab, var1->dv,
4527 dv_htab_hash (var1->dv));
4528 if (!var2)
4530 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
4532 fprintf (dump_file, "dataflow difference found: removal of:\n");
4533 dump_var (var1);
4535 return true;
4538 if (variable_different_p (var1, var2))
4540 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
4542 fprintf (dump_file, "dataflow difference found: "
4543 "old and new follow:\n");
4544 dump_var (var1);
4545 dump_var (var2);
4547 return true;
4551 /* No need to traverse the second hashtab, if both have the same number
4552 of elements and the second one had all entries found in the first one,
4553 then it can't have any extra entries. */
4554 return false;
4557 /* Free the contents of dataflow set SET. */
4559 static void
4560 dataflow_set_destroy (dataflow_set *set)
4562 int i;
4564 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
4565 attrs_list_clear (&set->regs[i]);
4567 shared_hash_destroy (set->vars);
4568 set->vars = NULL;
4571 /* Return true if RTL X contains a SYMBOL_REF. */
4573 static bool
4574 contains_symbol_ref (rtx x)
4576 const char *fmt;
4577 RTX_CODE code;
4578 int i;
4580 if (!x)
4581 return false;
4583 code = GET_CODE (x);
4584 if (code == SYMBOL_REF)
4585 return true;
4587 fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
4588 for (i = GET_RTX_LENGTH (code) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
4590 if (fmt[i] == 'e')
4592 if (contains_symbol_ref (XEXP (x, i)))
4593 return true;
4595 else if (fmt[i] == 'E')
4597 int j;
4598 for (j = 0; j < XVECLEN (x, i); j++)
4599 if (contains_symbol_ref (XVECEXP (x, i, j)))
4600 return true;
4604 return false;
4607 /* Shall EXPR be tracked? */
4609 static bool
4610 track_expr_p (tree expr, bool need_rtl)
4612 rtx decl_rtl;
4613 tree realdecl;
4615 if (TREE_CODE (expr) == DEBUG_EXPR_DECL)
4616 return DECL_RTL_SET_P (expr);
4618 /* If EXPR is not a parameter or a variable do not track it. */
4619 if (TREE_CODE (expr) != VAR_DECL && TREE_CODE (expr) != PARM_DECL)
4620 return 0;
4622 /* It also must have a name... */
4623 if (!DECL_NAME (expr) && need_rtl)
4624 return 0;
4626 /* ... and a RTL assigned to it. */
4627 decl_rtl = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (expr);
4628 if (!decl_rtl && need_rtl)
4629 return 0;
4631 /* If this expression is really a debug alias of some other declaration, we
4632 don't need to track this expression if the ultimate declaration is
4633 ignored. */
4634 realdecl = expr;
4635 if (DECL_DEBUG_EXPR_IS_FROM (realdecl))
4637 realdecl = DECL_DEBUG_EXPR (realdecl);
4638 if (realdecl == NULL_TREE)
4639 realdecl = expr;
4640 else if (!DECL_P (realdecl))
4642 if (handled_component_p (realdecl))
4644 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos, maxsize;
4645 tree innerdecl
4646 = get_ref_base_and_extent (realdecl, &bitpos, &bitsize,
4647 &maxsize);
4648 if (!DECL_P (innerdecl)
4649 || DECL_IGNORED_P (innerdecl)
4650 || TREE_STATIC (innerdecl)
4651 || bitsize <= 0
4652 || bitpos + bitsize > 256
4653 || bitsize != maxsize)
4654 return 0;
4655 else
4656 realdecl = expr;
4658 else
4659 return 0;
4663 /* Do not track EXPR if REALDECL it should be ignored for debugging
4664 purposes. */
4665 if (DECL_IGNORED_P (realdecl))
4666 return 0;
4668 /* Do not track global variables until we are able to emit correct location
4669 list for them. */
4670 if (TREE_STATIC (realdecl))
4671 return 0;
4673 /* When the EXPR is a DECL for alias of some variable (see example)
4674 the TREE_STATIC flag is not used. Disable tracking all DECLs whose
4675 DECL_RTL contains SYMBOL_REF.
4677 Example:
4678 extern char **_dl_argv_internal __attribute__ ((alias ("_dl_argv")));
4679 char **_dl_argv;
4681 if (decl_rtl && MEM_P (decl_rtl)
4682 && contains_symbol_ref (XEXP (decl_rtl, 0)))
4683 return 0;
4685 /* If RTX is a memory it should not be very large (because it would be
4686 an array or struct). */
4687 if (decl_rtl && MEM_P (decl_rtl))
4689 /* Do not track structures and arrays. */
4690 if (GET_MODE (decl_rtl) == BLKmode
4691 || AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (realdecl)))
4692 return 0;
4693 if (MEM_SIZE_KNOWN_P (decl_rtl)
4694 && MEM_SIZE (decl_rtl) > MAX_VAR_PARTS)
4695 return 0;
4698 DECL_CHANGED (expr) = 0;
4699 DECL_CHANGED (realdecl) = 0;
4700 return 1;
4703 /* Determine whether a given LOC refers to the same variable part as
4704 EXPR+OFFSET. */
4706 static bool
4707 same_variable_part_p (rtx loc, tree expr, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
4709 tree expr2;
4710 HOST_WIDE_INT offset2;
4712 if (! DECL_P (expr))
4713 return false;
4715 if (REG_P (loc))
4717 expr2 = REG_EXPR (loc);
4718 offset2 = REG_OFFSET (loc);
4720 else if (MEM_P (loc))
4722 expr2 = MEM_EXPR (loc);
4723 offset2 = INT_MEM_OFFSET (loc);
4725 else
4726 return false;
4728 if (! expr2 || ! DECL_P (expr2))
4729 return false;
4731 expr = var_debug_decl (expr);
4732 expr2 = var_debug_decl (expr2);
4734 return (expr == expr2 && offset == offset2);
4737 /* LOC is a REG or MEM that we would like to track if possible.
4738 If EXPR is null, we don't know what expression LOC refers to,
4739 otherwise it refers to EXPR + OFFSET. STORE_REG_P is true if
4740 LOC is an lvalue register.
4742 Return true if EXPR is nonnull and if LOC, or some lowpart of it,
4743 is something we can track. When returning true, store the mode of
4744 the lowpart we can track in *MODE_OUT (if nonnull) and its offset
4745 from EXPR in *OFFSET_OUT (if nonnull). */
4747 static bool
4748 track_loc_p (rtx loc, tree expr, HOST_WIDE_INT offset, bool store_reg_p,
4749 enum machine_mode *mode_out, HOST_WIDE_INT *offset_out)
4751 enum machine_mode mode;
4753 if (expr == NULL || !track_expr_p (expr, true))
4754 return false;
4756 /* If REG was a paradoxical subreg, its REG_ATTRS will describe the
4757 whole subreg, but only the old inner part is really relevant. */
4758 mode = GET_MODE (loc);
4759 if (REG_P (loc) && !HARD_REGISTER_NUM_P (ORIGINAL_REGNO (loc)))
4761 enum machine_mode pseudo_mode;
4763 pseudo_mode = PSEUDO_REGNO_MODE (ORIGINAL_REGNO (loc));
4764 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > GET_MODE_SIZE (pseudo_mode))
4766 offset += byte_lowpart_offset (pseudo_mode, mode);
4767 mode = pseudo_mode;
4771 /* If LOC is a paradoxical lowpart of EXPR, refer to EXPR itself.
4772 Do the same if we are storing to a register and EXPR occupies
4773 the whole of register LOC; in that case, the whole of EXPR is
4774 being changed. We exclude complex modes from the second case
4775 because the real and imaginary parts are represented as separate
4776 pseudo registers, even if the whole complex value fits into one
4777 hard register. */
4778 if ((GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > GET_MODE_SIZE (DECL_MODE (expr))
4779 || (store_reg_p
4780 && !COMPLEX_MODE_P (DECL_MODE (expr))
4781 && hard_regno_nregs[REGNO (loc)][DECL_MODE (expr)] == 1))
4782 && offset + byte_lowpart_offset (DECL_MODE (expr), mode) == 0)
4784 mode = DECL_MODE (expr);
4785 offset = 0;
4788 if (offset < 0 || offset >= MAX_VAR_PARTS)
4789 return false;
4791 if (mode_out)
4792 *mode_out = mode;
4793 if (offset_out)
4794 *offset_out = offset;
4795 return true;
4798 /* Return the MODE lowpart of LOC, or null if LOC is not something we
4799 want to track. When returning nonnull, make sure that the attributes
4800 on the returned value are updated. */
4802 static rtx
4803 var_lowpart (enum machine_mode mode, rtx loc)
4805 unsigned int offset, reg_offset, regno;
4807 if (!REG_P (loc) && !MEM_P (loc))
4808 return NULL;
4810 if (GET_MODE (loc) == mode)
4811 return loc;
4813 offset = byte_lowpart_offset (mode, GET_MODE (loc));
4815 if (MEM_P (loc))
4816 return adjust_address_nv (loc, mode, offset);
4818 reg_offset = subreg_lowpart_offset (mode, GET_MODE (loc));
4819 regno = REGNO (loc) + subreg_regno_offset (REGNO (loc), GET_MODE (loc),
4820 reg_offset, mode);
4821 return gen_rtx_REG_offset (loc, mode, regno, offset);
4824 /* Carry information about uses and stores while walking rtx. */
4826 struct count_use_info
4828 /* The insn where the RTX is. */
4829 rtx insn;
4831 /* The basic block where insn is. */
4832 basic_block bb;
4834 /* The array of n_sets sets in the insn, as determined by cselib. */
4835 struct cselib_set *sets;
4836 int n_sets;
4838 /* True if we're counting stores, false otherwise. */
4839 bool store_p;
4842 /* Find a VALUE corresponding to X. */
4844 static inline cselib_val *
4845 find_use_val (rtx x, enum machine_mode mode, struct count_use_info *cui)
4847 int i;
4849 if (cui->sets)
4851 /* This is called after uses are set up and before stores are
4852 processed by cselib, so it's safe to look up srcs, but not
4853 dsts. So we look up expressions that appear in srcs or in
4854 dest expressions, but we search the sets array for dests of
4855 stores. */
4856 if (cui->store_p)
4858 /* Some targets represent memset and memcpy patterns
4859 by (set (mem:BLK ...) (reg:[QHSD]I ...)) or
4860 (set (mem:BLK ...) (const_int ...)) or
4861 (set (mem:BLK ...) (mem:BLK ...)). Don't return anything
4862 in that case, otherwise we end up with mode mismatches. */
4863 if (mode == BLKmode && MEM_P (x))
4864 return NULL;
4865 for (i = 0; i < cui->n_sets; i++)
4866 if (cui->sets[i].dest == x)
4867 return cui->sets[i].src_elt;
4869 else
4870 return cselib_lookup (x, mode, 0, VOIDmode);
4873 return NULL;
4876 /* Helper function to get mode of MEM's address. */
4878 static inline enum machine_mode
4879 get_address_mode (rtx mem)
4881 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (mem, 0));
4882 if (mode != VOIDmode)
4883 return mode;
4884 return targetm.addr_space.address_mode (MEM_ADDR_SPACE (mem));
4887 /* Replace all registers and addresses in an expression with VALUE
4888 expressions that map back to them, unless the expression is a
4889 register. If no mapping is or can be performed, returns NULL. */
4891 static rtx
4892 replace_expr_with_values (rtx loc)
4894 if (REG_P (loc) || GET_CODE (loc) == ENTRY_VALUE)
4895 return NULL;
4896 else if (MEM_P (loc))
4898 cselib_val *addr = cselib_lookup (XEXP (loc, 0),
4899 get_address_mode (loc), 0,
4900 GET_MODE (loc));
4901 if (addr)
4902 return replace_equiv_address_nv (loc, addr->val_rtx);
4903 else
4904 return NULL;
4906 else
4907 return cselib_subst_to_values (loc, VOIDmode);
4910 /* Return true if *X is a DEBUG_EXPR. Usable as an argument to
4911 for_each_rtx to tell whether there are any DEBUG_EXPRs within
4912 RTX. */
4914 static int
4915 rtx_debug_expr_p (rtx *x, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
4917 rtx loc = *x;
4919 return GET_CODE (loc) == DEBUG_EXPR;
4922 /* Determine what kind of micro operation to choose for a USE. Return
4923 MO_CLOBBER if no micro operation is to be generated. */
4925 static enum micro_operation_type
4926 use_type (rtx loc, struct count_use_info *cui, enum machine_mode *modep)
4928 tree expr;
4930 if (cui && cui->sets)
4932 if (GET_CODE (loc) == VAR_LOCATION)
4934 if (track_expr_p (PAT_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (loc), false))
4936 rtx ploc = PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc);
4937 if (! VAR_LOC_UNKNOWN_P (ploc))
4939 cselib_val *val = cselib_lookup (ploc, GET_MODE (loc), 1,
4940 VOIDmode);
4942 /* ??? flag_float_store and volatile mems are never
4943 given values, but we could in theory use them for
4944 locations. */
4945 gcc_assert (val || 1);
4947 return MO_VAL_LOC;
4949 else
4950 return MO_CLOBBER;
4953 if (REG_P (loc) || MEM_P (loc))
4955 if (modep)
4956 *modep = GET_MODE (loc);
4957 if (cui->store_p)
4959 if (REG_P (loc)
4960 || (find_use_val (loc, GET_MODE (loc), cui)
4961 && cselib_lookup (XEXP (loc, 0),
4962 get_address_mode (loc), 0,
4963 GET_MODE (loc))))
4964 return MO_VAL_SET;
4966 else
4968 cselib_val *val = find_use_val (loc, GET_MODE (loc), cui);
4970 if (val && !cselib_preserved_value_p (val))
4971 return MO_VAL_USE;
4976 if (REG_P (loc))
4978 gcc_assert (REGNO (loc) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER);
4980 if (loc == cfa_base_rtx)
4981 return MO_CLOBBER;
4982 expr = REG_EXPR (loc);
4984 if (!expr)
4985 return MO_USE_NO_VAR;
4986 else if (target_for_debug_bind (var_debug_decl (expr)))
4987 return MO_CLOBBER;
4988 else if (track_loc_p (loc, expr, REG_OFFSET (loc),
4989 false, modep, NULL))
4990 return MO_USE;
4991 else
4992 return MO_USE_NO_VAR;
4994 else if (MEM_P (loc))
4996 expr = MEM_EXPR (loc);
4998 if (!expr)
4999 return MO_CLOBBER;
5000 else if (target_for_debug_bind (var_debug_decl (expr)))
5001 return MO_CLOBBER;
5002 else if (track_loc_p (loc, expr, INT_MEM_OFFSET (loc),
5003 false, modep, NULL)
5004 /* Multi-part variables shouldn't refer to one-part
5005 variable names such as VALUEs (never happens) or
5006 DEBUG_EXPRs (only happens in the presence of debug
5007 insns). */
5008 && (!MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_INSNS
5009 || !for_each_rtx (&XEXP (loc, 0), rtx_debug_expr_p, NULL)))
5010 return MO_USE;
5011 else
5012 return MO_CLOBBER;
5015 return MO_CLOBBER;
5018 /* Log to OUT information about micro-operation MOPT involving X in
5019 INSN of BB. */
5021 static inline void
5022 log_op_type (rtx x, basic_block bb, rtx insn,
5023 enum micro_operation_type mopt, FILE *out)
5025 fprintf (out, "bb %i op %i insn %i %s ",
5026 bb->index, VEC_length (micro_operation, VTI (bb)->mos),
5027 INSN_UID (insn), micro_operation_type_name[mopt]);
5028 print_inline_rtx (out, x, 2);
5029 fputc ('\n', out);
5032 /* Tell whether the CONCAT used to holds a VALUE and its location
5033 needs value resolution, i.e., an attempt of mapping the location
5034 back to other incoming values. */
5035 #define VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION(x) \
5036 (RTL_FLAG_CHECK1 ("VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION", (x), CONCAT)->volatil)
5037 /* Whether the location in the CONCAT is a tracked expression, that
5038 should also be handled like a MO_USE. */
5039 #define VAL_HOLDS_TRACK_EXPR(x) \
5040 (RTL_FLAG_CHECK1 ("VAL_HOLDS_TRACK_EXPR", (x), CONCAT)->used)
5041 /* Whether the location in the CONCAT should be handled like a MO_COPY
5042 as well. */
5043 #define VAL_EXPR_IS_COPIED(x) \
5044 (RTL_FLAG_CHECK1 ("VAL_EXPR_IS_COPIED", (x), CONCAT)->jump)
5045 /* Whether the location in the CONCAT should be handled like a
5046 MO_CLOBBER as well. */
5047 #define VAL_EXPR_IS_CLOBBERED(x) \
5048 (RTL_FLAG_CHECK1 ("VAL_EXPR_IS_CLOBBERED", (x), CONCAT)->unchanging)
5049 /* Whether the location is a CONCAT of the MO_VAL_SET expression and
5050 a reverse operation that should be handled afterwards. */
5051 #define VAL_EXPR_HAS_REVERSE(x) \
5052 (RTL_FLAG_CHECK1 ("VAL_EXPR_HAS_REVERSE", (x), CONCAT)->return_val)
5054 /* All preserved VALUEs. */
5055 static VEC (rtx, heap) *preserved_values;
5057 /* Ensure VAL is preserved and remember it in a vector for vt_emit_notes. */
5059 static void
5060 preserve_value (cselib_val *val)
5062 cselib_preserve_value (val);
5063 VEC_safe_push (rtx, heap, preserved_values, val->val_rtx);
5066 /* Helper function for MO_VAL_LOC handling. Return non-zero if
5067 any rtxes not suitable for CONST use not replaced by VALUEs
5068 are discovered. */
5070 static int
5071 non_suitable_const (rtx *x, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
5073 if (*x == NULL_RTX)
5074 return 0;
5076 switch (GET_CODE (*x))
5078 case REG:
5079 case DEBUG_EXPR:
5080 case PC:
5081 case SCRATCH:
5082 case CC0:
5083 case ASM_INPUT:
5084 case ASM_OPERANDS:
5085 return 1;
5086 case MEM:
5087 return !MEM_READONLY_P (*x);
5088 default:
5089 return 0;
5093 /* Add uses (register and memory references) LOC which will be tracked
5094 to VTI (bb)->mos. INSN is instruction which the LOC is part of. */
5096 static int
5097 add_uses (rtx *ploc, void *data)
5099 rtx loc = *ploc;
5100 enum machine_mode mode = VOIDmode;
5101 struct count_use_info *cui = (struct count_use_info *)data;
5102 enum micro_operation_type type = use_type (loc, cui, &mode);
5104 if (type != MO_CLOBBER)
5106 basic_block bb = cui->bb;
5107 micro_operation mo;
5109 mo.type = type;
5110 mo.u.loc = type == MO_USE ? var_lowpart (mode, loc) : loc;
5111 mo.insn = cui->insn;
5113 if (type == MO_VAL_LOC)
5115 rtx oloc = loc;
5116 rtx vloc = PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (oloc);
5117 cselib_val *val;
5119 gcc_assert (cui->sets);
5121 if (MEM_P (vloc)
5122 && !REG_P (XEXP (vloc, 0))
5123 && !MEM_P (XEXP (vloc, 0)))
5125 rtx mloc = vloc;
5126 enum machine_mode address_mode = get_address_mode (mloc);
5127 cselib_val *val
5128 = cselib_lookup (XEXP (mloc, 0), address_mode, 0,
5129 GET_MODE (mloc));
5131 if (val && !cselib_preserved_value_p (val))
5133 micro_operation moa;
5134 preserve_value (val);
5136 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (mloc, 0)) != ENTRY_VALUE
5137 && (GET_CODE (XEXP (mloc, 0)) != PLUS
5138 || XEXP (XEXP (mloc, 0), 0) != cfa_base_rtx
5139 || !CONST_INT_P (XEXP (XEXP (mloc, 0), 1))))
5141 mloc = cselib_subst_to_values (XEXP (mloc, 0),
5142 GET_MODE (mloc));
5143 moa.type = MO_VAL_USE;
5144 moa.insn = cui->insn;
5145 moa.u.loc = gen_rtx_CONCAT (address_mode,
5146 val->val_rtx, mloc);
5147 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
5148 log_op_type (moa.u.loc, cui->bb, cui->insn,
5149 moa.type, dump_file);
5150 VEC_safe_push (micro_operation, heap, VTI (bb)->mos,
5151 &moa);
5156 if (CONSTANT_P (vloc)
5157 && (GET_CODE (vloc) != CONST
5158 || for_each_rtx (&vloc, non_suitable_const, NULL)))
5159 /* For constants don't look up any value. */;
5160 else if (!VAR_LOC_UNKNOWN_P (vloc) && !unsuitable_loc (vloc)
5161 && (val = find_use_val (vloc, GET_MODE (oloc), cui)))
5163 enum machine_mode mode2;
5164 enum micro_operation_type type2;
5165 rtx nloc = replace_expr_with_values (vloc);
5167 if (nloc)
5169 oloc = shallow_copy_rtx (oloc);
5170 PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (oloc) = nloc;
5173 oloc = gen_rtx_CONCAT (mode, val->val_rtx, oloc);
5175 type2 = use_type (vloc, 0, &mode2);
5177 gcc_assert (type2 == MO_USE || type2 == MO_USE_NO_VAR
5178 || type2 == MO_CLOBBER);
5180 if (type2 == MO_CLOBBER
5181 && !cselib_preserved_value_p (val))
5183 VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION (oloc) = 1;
5184 preserve_value (val);
5187 else if (!VAR_LOC_UNKNOWN_P (vloc))
5189 oloc = shallow_copy_rtx (oloc);
5190 PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (oloc) = gen_rtx_UNKNOWN_VAR_LOC ();
5193 mo.u.loc = oloc;
5195 else if (type == MO_VAL_USE)
5197 enum machine_mode mode2 = VOIDmode;
5198 enum micro_operation_type type2;
5199 cselib_val *val = find_use_val (loc, GET_MODE (loc), cui);
5200 rtx vloc, oloc = loc, nloc;
5202 gcc_assert (cui->sets);
5204 if (MEM_P (oloc)
5205 && !REG_P (XEXP (oloc, 0))
5206 && !MEM_P (XEXP (oloc, 0)))
5208 rtx mloc = oloc;
5209 enum machine_mode address_mode = get_address_mode (mloc);
5210 cselib_val *val
5211 = cselib_lookup (XEXP (mloc, 0), address_mode, 0,
5212 GET_MODE (mloc));
5214 if (val && !cselib_preserved_value_p (val))
5216 micro_operation moa;
5217 preserve_value (val);
5219 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (mloc, 0)) != ENTRY_VALUE
5220 && (GET_CODE (XEXP (mloc, 0)) != PLUS
5221 || XEXP (XEXP (mloc, 0), 0) != cfa_base_rtx
5222 || !CONST_INT_P (XEXP (XEXP (mloc, 0), 1))))
5224 mloc = cselib_subst_to_values (XEXP (mloc, 0),
5225 GET_MODE (mloc));
5226 moa.type = MO_VAL_USE;
5227 moa.insn = cui->insn;
5228 moa.u.loc = gen_rtx_CONCAT (address_mode,
5229 val->val_rtx, mloc);
5230 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
5231 log_op_type (moa.u.loc, cui->bb, cui->insn,
5232 moa.type, dump_file);
5233 VEC_safe_push (micro_operation, heap, VTI (bb)->mos,
5234 &moa);
5239 type2 = use_type (loc, 0, &mode2);
5241 gcc_assert (type2 == MO_USE || type2 == MO_USE_NO_VAR
5242 || type2 == MO_CLOBBER);
5244 if (type2 == MO_USE)
5245 vloc = var_lowpart (mode2, loc);
5246 else
5247 vloc = oloc;
5249 /* The loc of a MO_VAL_USE may have two forms:
5251 (concat val src): val is at src, a value-based
5252 representation.
5254 (concat (concat val use) src): same as above, with use as
5255 the MO_USE tracked value, if it differs from src.
5259 nloc = replace_expr_with_values (loc);
5260 if (!nloc)
5261 nloc = oloc;
5263 if (vloc != nloc)
5264 oloc = gen_rtx_CONCAT (mode2, val->val_rtx, vloc);
5265 else
5266 oloc = val->val_rtx;
5268 mo.u.loc = gen_rtx_CONCAT (mode, oloc, nloc);
5270 if (type2 == MO_USE)
5271 VAL_HOLDS_TRACK_EXPR (mo.u.loc) = 1;
5272 if (!cselib_preserved_value_p (val))
5274 VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION (mo.u.loc) = 1;
5275 preserve_value (val);
5278 else
5279 gcc_assert (type == MO_USE || type == MO_USE_NO_VAR);
5281 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
5282 log_op_type (mo.u.loc, cui->bb, cui->insn, mo.type, dump_file);
5283 VEC_safe_push (micro_operation, heap, VTI (bb)->mos, &mo);
5286 return 0;
5289 /* Helper function for finding all uses of REG/MEM in X in insn INSN. */
5291 static void
5292 add_uses_1 (rtx *x, void *cui)
5294 for_each_rtx (x, add_uses, cui);
5297 /* This is the value used during expansion of locations. We want it
5298 to be unbounded, so that variables expanded deep in a recursion
5299 nest are fully evaluated, so that their values are cached
5300 correctly. We avoid recursion cycles through other means, and we
5301 don't unshare RTL, so excess complexity is not a problem. */
5302 #define EXPR_DEPTH (INT_MAX)
5303 /* We use this to keep too-complex expressions from being emitted as
5304 location notes, and then to debug information. Users can trade
5305 compile time for ridiculously complex expressions, although they're
5306 seldom useful, and they may often have to be discarded as not
5307 representable anyway. */
5308 #define EXPR_USE_DEPTH (PARAM_VALUE (PARAM_MAX_VARTRACK_EXPR_DEPTH))
5310 /* Attempt to reverse the EXPR operation in the debug info. Say for
5311 reg1 = reg2 + 6 even when reg2 is no longer live we
5312 can express its value as VAL - 6. */
5314 static rtx
5315 reverse_op (rtx val, const_rtx expr)
5317 rtx src, arg, ret;
5318 cselib_val *v;
5319 enum rtx_code code;
5321 if (GET_CODE (expr) != SET)
5322 return NULL_RTX;
5324 if (!REG_P (SET_DEST (expr)) || GET_MODE (val) != GET_MODE (SET_DEST (expr)))
5325 return NULL_RTX;
5327 src = SET_SRC (expr);
5328 switch (GET_CODE (src))
5330 case PLUS:
5331 case MINUS:
5332 case XOR:
5333 case NOT:
5334 case NEG:
5335 if (!REG_P (XEXP (src, 0)))
5336 return NULL_RTX;
5337 break;
5338 case SIGN_EXTEND:
5339 case ZERO_EXTEND:
5340 if (!REG_P (XEXP (src, 0)) && !MEM_P (XEXP (src, 0)))
5341 return NULL_RTX;
5342 break;
5343 default:
5344 return NULL_RTX;
5347 if (!SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (GET_MODE (src)) || XEXP (src, 0) == cfa_base_rtx)
5348 return NULL_RTX;
5350 v = cselib_lookup (XEXP (src, 0), GET_MODE (XEXP (src, 0)), 0, VOIDmode);
5351 if (!v || !cselib_preserved_value_p (v))
5352 return NULL_RTX;
5354 switch (GET_CODE (src))
5356 case NOT:
5357 case NEG:
5358 if (GET_MODE (v->val_rtx) != GET_MODE (val))
5359 return NULL_RTX;
5360 ret = gen_rtx_fmt_e (GET_CODE (src), GET_MODE (val), val);
5361 break;
5362 case SIGN_EXTEND:
5363 case ZERO_EXTEND:
5364 ret = gen_lowpart_SUBREG (GET_MODE (v->val_rtx), val);
5365 break;
5366 case XOR:
5367 code = XOR;
5368 goto binary;
5369 case PLUS:
5370 code = MINUS;
5371 goto binary;
5372 case MINUS:
5373 code = PLUS;
5374 goto binary;
5375 binary:
5376 if (GET_MODE (v->val_rtx) != GET_MODE (val))
5377 return NULL_RTX;
5378 arg = XEXP (src, 1);
5379 if (!CONST_INT_P (arg) && GET_CODE (arg) != SYMBOL_REF)
5381 arg = cselib_expand_value_rtx (arg, scratch_regs, 5);
5382 if (arg == NULL_RTX)
5383 return NULL_RTX;
5384 if (!CONST_INT_P (arg) && GET_CODE (arg) != SYMBOL_REF)
5385 return NULL_RTX;
5387 ret = simplify_gen_binary (code, GET_MODE (val), val, arg);
5388 if (ret == val)
5389 /* Ensure ret isn't VALUE itself (which can happen e.g. for
5390 (plus (reg1) (reg2)) when reg2 is known to be 0), as that
5391 breaks a lot of routines during var-tracking. */
5392 ret = gen_rtx_fmt_ee (PLUS, GET_MODE (val), val, const0_rtx);
5393 break;
5394 default:
5395 gcc_unreachable ();
5398 return gen_rtx_CONCAT (GET_MODE (v->val_rtx), v->val_rtx, ret);
5401 /* Add stores (register and memory references) LOC which will be tracked
5402 to VTI (bb)->mos. EXPR is the RTL expression containing the store.
5403 CUIP->insn is instruction which the LOC is part of. */
5405 static void
5406 add_stores (rtx loc, const_rtx expr, void *cuip)
5408 enum machine_mode mode = VOIDmode, mode2;
5409 struct count_use_info *cui = (struct count_use_info *)cuip;
5410 basic_block bb = cui->bb;
5411 micro_operation mo;
5412 rtx oloc = loc, nloc, src = NULL;
5413 enum micro_operation_type type = use_type (loc, cui, &mode);
5414 bool track_p = false;
5415 cselib_val *v;
5416 bool resolve, preserve;
5417 rtx reverse;
5419 if (type == MO_CLOBBER)
5420 return;
5422 mode2 = mode;
5424 if (REG_P (loc))
5426 gcc_assert (loc != cfa_base_rtx);
5427 if ((GET_CODE (expr) == CLOBBER && type != MO_VAL_SET)
5428 || !(track_p = use_type (loc, NULL, &mode2) == MO_USE)
5429 || GET_CODE (expr) == CLOBBER)
5431 mo.type = MO_CLOBBER;
5432 mo.u.loc = loc;
5433 if (GET_CODE (expr) == SET
5434 && SET_DEST (expr) == loc
5435 && !unsuitable_loc (SET_SRC (expr))
5436 && find_use_val (loc, mode, cui))
5438 gcc_checking_assert (type == MO_VAL_SET);
5439 mo.u.loc = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, loc, SET_SRC (expr));
5442 else
5444 if (GET_CODE (expr) == SET
5445 && SET_DEST (expr) == loc
5446 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (expr)) != ASM_OPERANDS)
5447 src = var_lowpart (mode2, SET_SRC (expr));
5448 loc = var_lowpart (mode2, loc);
5450 if (src == NULL)
5452 mo.type = MO_SET;
5453 mo.u.loc = loc;
5455 else
5457 rtx xexpr = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, loc, src);
5458 if (same_variable_part_p (src, REG_EXPR (loc), REG_OFFSET (loc)))
5459 mo.type = MO_COPY;
5460 else
5461 mo.type = MO_SET;
5462 mo.u.loc = xexpr;
5465 mo.insn = cui->insn;
5467 else if (MEM_P (loc)
5468 && ((track_p = use_type (loc, NULL, &mode2) == MO_USE)
5469 || cui->sets))
5471 if (MEM_P (loc) && type == MO_VAL_SET
5472 && !REG_P (XEXP (loc, 0))
5473 && !MEM_P (XEXP (loc, 0)))
5475 rtx mloc = loc;
5476 enum machine_mode address_mode = get_address_mode (mloc);
5477 cselib_val *val = cselib_lookup (XEXP (mloc, 0),
5478 address_mode, 0,
5479 GET_MODE (mloc));
5481 if (val && !cselib_preserved_value_p (val))
5483 preserve_value (val);
5485 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (mloc, 0)) != ENTRY_VALUE
5486 && (GET_CODE (XEXP (mloc, 0)) != PLUS
5487 || XEXP (XEXP (mloc, 0), 0) != cfa_base_rtx
5488 || !CONST_INT_P (XEXP (XEXP (mloc, 0), 1))))
5490 mloc = cselib_subst_to_values (XEXP (mloc, 0),
5491 GET_MODE (mloc));
5492 mo.type = MO_VAL_USE;
5493 mo.insn = cui->insn;
5494 mo.u.loc = gen_rtx_CONCAT (address_mode,
5495 val->val_rtx, mloc);
5496 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
5497 log_op_type (mo.u.loc, cui->bb, cui->insn,
5498 mo.type, dump_file);
5499 VEC_safe_push (micro_operation, heap, VTI (bb)->mos, &mo);
5504 if (GET_CODE (expr) == CLOBBER || !track_p)
5506 mo.type = MO_CLOBBER;
5507 mo.u.loc = track_p ? var_lowpart (mode2, loc) : loc;
5509 else
5511 if (GET_CODE (expr) == SET
5512 && SET_DEST (expr) == loc
5513 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (expr)) != ASM_OPERANDS)
5514 src = var_lowpart (mode2, SET_SRC (expr));
5515 loc = var_lowpart (mode2, loc);
5517 if (src == NULL)
5519 mo.type = MO_SET;
5520 mo.u.loc = loc;
5522 else
5524 rtx xexpr = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, loc, src);
5525 if (same_variable_part_p (SET_SRC (xexpr),
5526 MEM_EXPR (loc),
5527 INT_MEM_OFFSET (loc)))
5528 mo.type = MO_COPY;
5529 else
5530 mo.type = MO_SET;
5531 mo.u.loc = xexpr;
5534 mo.insn = cui->insn;
5536 else
5537 return;
5539 if (type != MO_VAL_SET)
5540 goto log_and_return;
5542 v = find_use_val (oloc, mode, cui);
5544 if (!v)
5545 goto log_and_return;
5547 resolve = preserve = !cselib_preserved_value_p (v);
5549 nloc = replace_expr_with_values (oloc);
5550 if (nloc)
5551 oloc = nloc;
5553 if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (cui->insn)) == COND_EXEC)
5555 cselib_val *oval = cselib_lookup (oloc, GET_MODE (oloc), 0, VOIDmode);
5557 gcc_assert (oval != v);
5558 gcc_assert (REG_P (oloc) || MEM_P (oloc));
5560 if (!cselib_preserved_value_p (oval))
5562 micro_operation moa;
5564 preserve_value (oval);
5566 moa.type = MO_VAL_USE;
5567 moa.u.loc = gen_rtx_CONCAT (mode, oval->val_rtx, oloc);
5568 VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION (moa.u.loc) = 1;
5569 moa.insn = cui->insn;
5571 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
5572 log_op_type (moa.u.loc, cui->bb, cui->insn,
5573 moa.type, dump_file);
5574 VEC_safe_push (micro_operation, heap, VTI (bb)->mos, &moa);
5577 resolve = false;
5579 else if (resolve && GET_CODE (mo.u.loc) == SET)
5581 nloc = replace_expr_with_values (SET_SRC (expr));
5583 /* Avoid the mode mismatch between oexpr and expr. */
5584 if (!nloc && mode != mode2)
5586 nloc = SET_SRC (expr);
5587 gcc_assert (oloc == SET_DEST (expr));
5590 if (nloc)
5591 oloc = gen_rtx_SET (GET_MODE (mo.u.loc), oloc, nloc);
5592 else
5594 if (oloc == SET_DEST (mo.u.loc))
5595 /* No point in duplicating. */
5596 oloc = mo.u.loc;
5597 if (!REG_P (SET_SRC (mo.u.loc)))
5598 resolve = false;
5601 else if (!resolve)
5603 if (GET_CODE (mo.u.loc) == SET
5604 && oloc == SET_DEST (mo.u.loc))
5605 /* No point in duplicating. */
5606 oloc = mo.u.loc;
5608 else
5609 resolve = false;
5611 loc = gen_rtx_CONCAT (mode, v->val_rtx, oloc);
5613 if (mo.u.loc != oloc)
5614 loc = gen_rtx_CONCAT (GET_MODE (mo.u.loc), loc, mo.u.loc);
5616 /* The loc of a MO_VAL_SET may have various forms:
5618 (concat val dst): dst now holds val
5620 (concat val (set dst src)): dst now holds val, copied from src
5622 (concat (concat val dstv) dst): dst now holds val; dstv is dst
5623 after replacing mems and non-top-level regs with values.
5625 (concat (concat val dstv) (set dst src)): dst now holds val,
5626 copied from src. dstv is a value-based representation of dst, if
5627 it differs from dst. If resolution is needed, src is a REG, and
5628 its mode is the same as that of val.
5630 (concat (concat val (set dstv srcv)) (set dst src)): src
5631 copied to dst, holding val. dstv and srcv are value-based
5632 representations of dst and src, respectively.
5636 if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (cui->insn)) != COND_EXEC)
5638 reverse = reverse_op (v->val_rtx, expr);
5639 if (reverse)
5641 loc = gen_rtx_CONCAT (GET_MODE (mo.u.loc), loc, reverse);
5642 VAL_EXPR_HAS_REVERSE (loc) = 1;
5646 mo.u.loc = loc;
5648 if (track_p)
5649 VAL_HOLDS_TRACK_EXPR (loc) = 1;
5650 if (preserve)
5652 VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION (loc) = resolve;
5653 preserve_value (v);
5655 if (mo.type == MO_CLOBBER)
5656 VAL_EXPR_IS_CLOBBERED (loc) = 1;
5657 if (mo.type == MO_COPY)
5658 VAL_EXPR_IS_COPIED (loc) = 1;
5660 mo.type = MO_VAL_SET;
5662 log_and_return:
5663 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
5664 log_op_type (mo.u.loc, cui->bb, cui->insn, mo.type, dump_file);
5665 VEC_safe_push (micro_operation, heap, VTI (bb)->mos, &mo);
5668 /* Arguments to the call. */
5669 static rtx call_arguments;
5671 /* Compute call_arguments. */
5673 static void
5674 prepare_call_arguments (basic_block bb, rtx insn)
5676 rtx link, x;
5677 rtx prev, cur, next;
5678 rtx call = PATTERN (insn);
5679 rtx this_arg = NULL_RTX;
5680 tree type = NULL_TREE, t, fndecl = NULL_TREE;
5681 tree obj_type_ref = NULL_TREE;
5682 CUMULATIVE_ARGS args_so_far_v;
5683 cumulative_args_t args_so_far;
5685 memset (&args_so_far_v, 0, sizeof (args_so_far_v));
5686 args_so_far = pack_cumulative_args (&args_so_far_v);
5687 if (GET_CODE (call) == PARALLEL)
5688 call = XVECEXP (call, 0, 0);
5689 if (GET_CODE (call) == SET)
5690 call = SET_SRC (call);
5691 if (GET_CODE (call) == CALL && MEM_P (XEXP (call, 0)))
5693 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (call, 0), 0)) == SYMBOL_REF)
5695 rtx symbol = XEXP (XEXP (call, 0), 0);
5696 if (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (symbol))
5697 fndecl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (symbol);
5699 if (fndecl == NULL_TREE)
5700 fndecl = MEM_EXPR (XEXP (call, 0));
5701 if (fndecl
5702 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (fndecl)) != FUNCTION_TYPE
5703 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (fndecl)) != METHOD_TYPE)
5704 fndecl = NULL_TREE;
5705 if (fndecl && TYPE_ARG_TYPES (TREE_TYPE (fndecl)))
5706 type = TREE_TYPE (fndecl);
5707 if (fndecl && TREE_CODE (fndecl) != FUNCTION_DECL)
5709 if (TREE_CODE (fndecl) == INDIRECT_REF
5710 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (fndecl, 0)) == OBJ_TYPE_REF)
5711 obj_type_ref = TREE_OPERAND (fndecl, 0);
5712 fndecl = NULL_TREE;
5714 if (type)
5716 for (t = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (type); t && t != void_list_node;
5717 t = TREE_CHAIN (t))
5718 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_VALUE (t)) == REFERENCE_TYPE
5719 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (TREE_VALUE (t))))
5720 break;
5721 if ((t == NULL || t == void_list_node) && obj_type_ref == NULL_TREE)
5722 type = NULL;
5723 else
5725 int nargs ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED = list_length (TYPE_ARG_TYPES (type));
5726 link = CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (insn);
5727 #ifndef PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
5728 if (aggregate_value_p (TREE_TYPE (type), type)
5729 && targetm.calls.struct_value_rtx (type, 0) == 0)
5731 tree struct_addr = build_pointer_type (TREE_TYPE (type));
5732 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (struct_addr);
5733 rtx reg;
5734 INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (args_so_far_v, type, NULL_RTX, fndecl,
5735 nargs + 1);
5736 reg = targetm.calls.function_arg (args_so_far, mode,
5737 struct_addr, true);
5738 targetm.calls.function_arg_advance (args_so_far, mode,
5739 struct_addr, true);
5740 if (reg == NULL_RTX)
5742 for (; link; link = XEXP (link, 1))
5743 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (link, 0)) == USE
5744 && MEM_P (XEXP (XEXP (link, 0), 0)))
5746 link = XEXP (link, 1);
5747 break;
5751 else
5752 #endif
5753 INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (args_so_far_v, type, NULL_RTX, fndecl,
5754 nargs);
5755 if (obj_type_ref && TYPE_ARG_TYPES (type) != void_list_node)
5757 enum machine_mode mode;
5758 t = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (type);
5759 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_VALUE (t));
5760 this_arg = targetm.calls.function_arg (args_so_far, mode,
5761 TREE_VALUE (t), true);
5762 if (this_arg && !REG_P (this_arg))
5763 this_arg = NULL_RTX;
5764 else if (this_arg == NULL_RTX)
5766 for (; link; link = XEXP (link, 1))
5767 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (link, 0)) == USE
5768 && MEM_P (XEXP (XEXP (link, 0), 0)))
5770 this_arg = XEXP (XEXP (link, 0), 0);
5771 break;
5778 t = type ? TYPE_ARG_TYPES (type) : NULL_TREE;
5780 for (link = CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (insn); link; link = XEXP (link, 1))
5781 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (link, 0)) == USE)
5783 rtx item = NULL_RTX;
5784 x = XEXP (XEXP (link, 0), 0);
5785 if (GET_MODE (link) == VOIDmode
5786 || GET_MODE (link) == BLKmode
5787 || (GET_MODE (link) != GET_MODE (x)
5788 && (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (link)) != MODE_INT
5789 || GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (x)) != MODE_INT)))
5790 /* Can't do anything for these, if the original type mode
5791 isn't known or can't be converted. */;
5792 else if (REG_P (x))
5794 cselib_val *val = cselib_lookup (x, GET_MODE (x), 0, VOIDmode);
5795 if (val && cselib_preserved_value_p (val))
5796 item = val->val_rtx;
5797 else if (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (x)) == MODE_INT)
5799 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (x);
5801 while ((mode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (mode)) != VOIDmode
5802 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) <= BITS_PER_WORD)
5804 rtx reg = simplify_subreg (mode, x, GET_MODE (x), 0);
5806 if (reg == NULL_RTX || !REG_P (reg))
5807 continue;
5808 val = cselib_lookup (reg, mode, 0, VOIDmode);
5809 if (val && cselib_preserved_value_p (val))
5811 item = val->val_rtx;
5812 break;
5817 else if (MEM_P (x))
5819 rtx mem = x;
5820 cselib_val *val;
5822 if (!frame_pointer_needed)
5824 struct adjust_mem_data amd;
5825 amd.mem_mode = VOIDmode;
5826 amd.stack_adjust = -VTI (bb)->out.stack_adjust;
5827 amd.side_effects = NULL_RTX;
5828 amd.store = true;
5829 mem = simplify_replace_fn_rtx (mem, NULL_RTX, adjust_mems,
5830 &amd);
5831 gcc_assert (amd.side_effects == NULL_RTX);
5833 val = cselib_lookup (mem, GET_MODE (mem), 0, VOIDmode);
5834 if (val && cselib_preserved_value_p (val))
5835 item = val->val_rtx;
5836 else if (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (mem)) != MODE_INT)
5838 /* For non-integer stack argument see also if they weren't
5839 initialized by integers. */
5840 enum machine_mode imode = int_mode_for_mode (GET_MODE (mem));
5841 if (imode != GET_MODE (mem) && imode != BLKmode)
5843 val = cselib_lookup (adjust_address_nv (mem, imode, 0),
5844 imode, 0, VOIDmode);
5845 if (val && cselib_preserved_value_p (val))
5846 item = lowpart_subreg (GET_MODE (x), val->val_rtx,
5847 imode);
5851 if (item)
5853 rtx x2 = x;
5854 if (GET_MODE (item) != GET_MODE (link))
5855 item = lowpart_subreg (GET_MODE (link), item, GET_MODE (item));
5856 if (GET_MODE (x2) != GET_MODE (link))
5857 x2 = lowpart_subreg (GET_MODE (link), x2, GET_MODE (x2));
5858 item = gen_rtx_CONCAT (GET_MODE (link), x2, item);
5859 call_arguments
5860 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, item, call_arguments);
5862 if (t && t != void_list_node)
5864 tree argtype = TREE_VALUE (t);
5865 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (argtype);
5866 rtx reg;
5867 if (pass_by_reference (&args_so_far_v, mode, argtype, true))
5869 argtype = build_pointer_type (argtype);
5870 mode = TYPE_MODE (argtype);
5872 reg = targetm.calls.function_arg (args_so_far, mode,
5873 argtype, true);
5874 if (TREE_CODE (argtype) == REFERENCE_TYPE
5875 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (argtype))
5876 && reg
5877 && REG_P (reg)
5878 && GET_MODE (reg) == mode
5879 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
5880 && REG_P (x)
5881 && REGNO (x) == REGNO (reg)
5882 && GET_MODE (x) == mode
5883 && item)
5885 enum machine_mode indmode
5886 = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (argtype));
5887 rtx mem = gen_rtx_MEM (indmode, x);
5888 cselib_val *val = cselib_lookup (mem, indmode, 0, VOIDmode);
5889 if (val && cselib_preserved_value_p (val))
5891 item = gen_rtx_CONCAT (indmode, mem, val->val_rtx);
5892 call_arguments = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, item,
5893 call_arguments);
5895 else
5897 struct elt_loc_list *l;
5898 tree initial;
5900 /* Try harder, when passing address of a constant
5901 pool integer it can be easily read back. */
5902 item = XEXP (item, 1);
5903 if (GET_CODE (item) == SUBREG)
5904 item = SUBREG_REG (item);
5905 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (item) == VALUE);
5906 val = CSELIB_VAL_PTR (item);
5907 for (l = val->locs; l; l = l->next)
5908 if (GET_CODE (l->loc) == SYMBOL_REF
5909 && TREE_CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (l->loc)
5910 && SYMBOL_REF_DECL (l->loc)
5911 && DECL_INITIAL (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (l->loc)))
5913 initial = DECL_INITIAL (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (l->loc));
5914 if (host_integerp (initial, 0))
5916 item = GEN_INT (tree_low_cst (initial, 0));
5917 item = gen_rtx_CONCAT (indmode, mem, item);
5918 call_arguments
5919 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, item,
5920 call_arguments);
5922 break;
5926 targetm.calls.function_arg_advance (args_so_far, mode,
5927 argtype, true);
5928 t = TREE_CHAIN (t);
5932 /* Add debug arguments. */
5933 if (fndecl
5934 && TREE_CODE (fndecl) == FUNCTION_DECL
5935 && DECL_HAS_DEBUG_ARGS_P (fndecl))
5937 VEC(tree, gc) **debug_args = decl_debug_args_lookup (fndecl);
5938 if (debug_args)
5940 unsigned int ix;
5941 tree param;
5942 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (tree, *debug_args, ix, param); ix += 2)
5944 rtx item;
5945 tree dtemp = VEC_index (tree, *debug_args, ix + 1);
5946 enum machine_mode mode = DECL_MODE (dtemp);
5947 item = gen_rtx_DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF (mode, param);
5948 item = gen_rtx_CONCAT (mode, item, DECL_RTL_KNOWN_SET (dtemp));
5949 call_arguments = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, item,
5950 call_arguments);
5955 /* Reverse call_arguments chain. */
5956 prev = NULL_RTX;
5957 for (cur = call_arguments; cur; cur = next)
5959 next = XEXP (cur, 1);
5960 XEXP (cur, 1) = prev;
5961 prev = cur;
5963 call_arguments = prev;
5965 x = PATTERN (insn);
5966 if (GET_CODE (x) == PARALLEL)
5967 x = XVECEXP (x, 0, 0);
5968 if (GET_CODE (x) == SET)
5969 x = SET_SRC (x);
5970 if (GET_CODE (x) == CALL && MEM_P (XEXP (x, 0)))
5972 x = XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0);
5973 if (GET_CODE (x) == SYMBOL_REF)
5974 /* Don't record anything. */;
5975 else if (CONSTANT_P (x))
5977 x = gen_rtx_CONCAT (GET_MODE (x) == VOIDmode ? Pmode : GET_MODE (x),
5978 pc_rtx, x);
5979 call_arguments
5980 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, x, call_arguments);
5982 else
5984 cselib_val *val = cselib_lookup (x, GET_MODE (x), 0, VOIDmode);
5985 if (val && cselib_preserved_value_p (val))
5987 x = gen_rtx_CONCAT (GET_MODE (x), pc_rtx, val->val_rtx);
5988 call_arguments
5989 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, x, call_arguments);
5993 if (this_arg)
5995 enum machine_mode mode
5996 = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (OBJ_TYPE_REF_EXPR (obj_type_ref)));
5997 rtx clobbered = gen_rtx_MEM (mode, this_arg);
5998 HOST_WIDE_INT token
5999 = tree_low_cst (OBJ_TYPE_REF_TOKEN (obj_type_ref), 0);
6000 if (token)
6001 clobbered = plus_constant (clobbered, token * GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
6002 clobbered = gen_rtx_MEM (mode, clobbered);
6003 x = gen_rtx_CONCAT (mode, gen_rtx_CLOBBER (VOIDmode, pc_rtx), clobbered);
6004 call_arguments
6005 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, x, call_arguments);
6009 /* Callback for cselib_record_sets_hook, that records as micro
6010 operations uses and stores in an insn after cselib_record_sets has
6011 analyzed the sets in an insn, but before it modifies the stored
6012 values in the internal tables, unless cselib_record_sets doesn't
6013 call it directly (perhaps because we're not doing cselib in the
6014 first place, in which case sets and n_sets will be 0). */
6016 static void
6017 add_with_sets (rtx insn, struct cselib_set *sets, int n_sets)
6019 basic_block bb = BLOCK_FOR_INSN (insn);
6020 int n1, n2;
6021 struct count_use_info cui;
6022 micro_operation *mos;
6024 cselib_hook_called = true;
6026 cui.insn = insn;
6027 cui.bb = bb;
6028 cui.sets = sets;
6029 cui.n_sets = n_sets;
6031 n1 = VEC_length (micro_operation, VTI (bb)->mos);
6032 cui.store_p = false;
6033 note_uses (&PATTERN (insn), add_uses_1, &cui);
6034 n2 = VEC_length (micro_operation, VTI (bb)->mos) - 1;
6035 mos = VEC_address (micro_operation, VTI (bb)->mos);
6037 /* Order the MO_USEs to be before MO_USE_NO_VARs and MO_VAL_USE, and
6038 MO_VAL_LOC last. */
6039 while (n1 < n2)
6041 while (n1 < n2 && mos[n1].type == MO_USE)
6042 n1++;
6043 while (n1 < n2 && mos[n2].type != MO_USE)
6044 n2--;
6045 if (n1 < n2)
6047 micro_operation sw;
6049 sw = mos[n1];
6050 mos[n1] = mos[n2];
6051 mos[n2] = sw;
6055 n2 = VEC_length (micro_operation, VTI (bb)->mos) - 1;
6056 while (n1 < n2)
6058 while (n1 < n2 && mos[n1].type != MO_VAL_LOC)
6059 n1++;
6060 while (n1 < n2 && mos[n2].type == MO_VAL_LOC)
6061 n2--;
6062 if (n1 < n2)
6064 micro_operation sw;
6066 sw = mos[n1];
6067 mos[n1] = mos[n2];
6068 mos[n2] = sw;
6072 if (CALL_P (insn))
6074 micro_operation mo;
6076 mo.type = MO_CALL;
6077 mo.insn = insn;
6078 mo.u.loc = call_arguments;
6079 call_arguments = NULL_RTX;
6081 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
6082 log_op_type (PATTERN (insn), bb, insn, mo.type, dump_file);
6083 VEC_safe_push (micro_operation, heap, VTI (bb)->mos, &mo);
6086 n1 = VEC_length (micro_operation, VTI (bb)->mos);
6087 /* This will record NEXT_INSN (insn), such that we can
6088 insert notes before it without worrying about any
6089 notes that MO_USEs might emit after the insn. */
6090 cui.store_p = true;
6091 note_stores (PATTERN (insn), add_stores, &cui);
6092 n2 = VEC_length (micro_operation, VTI (bb)->mos) - 1;
6093 mos = VEC_address (micro_operation, VTI (bb)->mos);
6095 /* Order the MO_VAL_USEs first (note_stores does nothing
6096 on DEBUG_INSNs, so there are no MO_VAL_LOCs from this
6097 insn), then MO_CLOBBERs, then MO_SET/MO_COPY/MO_VAL_SET. */
6098 while (n1 < n2)
6100 while (n1 < n2 && mos[n1].type == MO_VAL_USE)
6101 n1++;
6102 while (n1 < n2 && mos[n2].type != MO_VAL_USE)
6103 n2--;
6104 if (n1 < n2)
6106 micro_operation sw;
6108 sw = mos[n1];
6109 mos[n1] = mos[n2];
6110 mos[n2] = sw;
6114 n2 = VEC_length (micro_operation, VTI (bb)->mos) - 1;
6115 while (n1 < n2)
6117 while (n1 < n2 && mos[n1].type == MO_CLOBBER)
6118 n1++;
6119 while (n1 < n2 && mos[n2].type != MO_CLOBBER)
6120 n2--;
6121 if (n1 < n2)
6123 micro_operation sw;
6125 sw = mos[n1];
6126 mos[n1] = mos[n2];
6127 mos[n2] = sw;
6132 static enum var_init_status
6133 find_src_status (dataflow_set *in, rtx src)
6135 tree decl = NULL_TREE;
6136 enum var_init_status status = VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED;
6138 if (! flag_var_tracking_uninit)
6139 status = VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED;
6141 if (src && REG_P (src))
6142 decl = var_debug_decl (REG_EXPR (src));
6143 else if (src && MEM_P (src))
6144 decl = var_debug_decl (MEM_EXPR (src));
6146 if (src && decl)
6147 status = get_init_value (in, src, dv_from_decl (decl));
6149 return status;
6152 /* SRC is the source of an assignment. Use SET to try to find what
6153 was ultimately assigned to SRC. Return that value if known,
6154 otherwise return SRC itself. */
6156 static rtx
6157 find_src_set_src (dataflow_set *set, rtx src)
6159 tree decl = NULL_TREE; /* The variable being copied around. */
6160 rtx set_src = NULL_RTX; /* The value for "decl" stored in "src". */
6161 variable var;
6162 location_chain nextp;
6163 int i;
6164 bool found;
6166 if (src && REG_P (src))
6167 decl = var_debug_decl (REG_EXPR (src));
6168 else if (src && MEM_P (src))
6169 decl = var_debug_decl (MEM_EXPR (src));
6171 if (src && decl)
6173 decl_or_value dv = dv_from_decl (decl);
6175 var = shared_hash_find (set->vars, dv);
6176 if (var)
6178 found = false;
6179 for (i = 0; i < var->n_var_parts && !found; i++)
6180 for (nextp = var->var_part[i].loc_chain; nextp && !found;
6181 nextp = nextp->next)
6182 if (rtx_equal_p (nextp->loc, src))
6184 set_src = nextp->set_src;
6185 found = true;
6191 return set_src;
6194 /* Compute the changes of variable locations in the basic block BB. */
6196 static bool
6197 compute_bb_dataflow (basic_block bb)
6199 unsigned int i;
6200 micro_operation *mo;
6201 bool changed;
6202 dataflow_set old_out;
6203 dataflow_set *in = &VTI (bb)->in;
6204 dataflow_set *out = &VTI (bb)->out;
6206 dataflow_set_init (&old_out);
6207 dataflow_set_copy (&old_out, out);
6208 dataflow_set_copy (out, in);
6210 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (micro_operation, VTI (bb)->mos, i, mo)
6212 rtx insn = mo->insn;
6214 switch (mo->type)
6216 case MO_CALL:
6217 dataflow_set_clear_at_call (out);
6218 break;
6220 case MO_USE:
6222 rtx loc = mo->u.loc;
6224 if (REG_P (loc))
6225 var_reg_set (out, loc, VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED, NULL);
6226 else if (MEM_P (loc))
6227 var_mem_set (out, loc, VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED, NULL);
6229 break;
6231 case MO_VAL_LOC:
6233 rtx loc = mo->u.loc;
6234 rtx val, vloc;
6235 tree var;
6237 if (GET_CODE (loc) == CONCAT)
6239 val = XEXP (loc, 0);
6240 vloc = XEXP (loc, 1);
6242 else
6244 val = NULL_RTX;
6245 vloc = loc;
6248 var = PAT_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (vloc);
6250 clobber_variable_part (out, NULL_RTX,
6251 dv_from_decl (var), 0, NULL_RTX);
6252 if (val)
6254 if (VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION (loc))
6255 val_resolve (out, val, PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (vloc), insn);
6256 set_variable_part (out, val, dv_from_decl (var), 0,
6257 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED, NULL_RTX,
6258 INSERT);
6260 else if (!VAR_LOC_UNKNOWN_P (PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (vloc)))
6261 set_variable_part (out, PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (vloc),
6262 dv_from_decl (var), 0,
6263 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED, NULL_RTX,
6264 INSERT);
6266 break;
6268 case MO_VAL_USE:
6270 rtx loc = mo->u.loc;
6271 rtx val, vloc, uloc;
6273 vloc = uloc = XEXP (loc, 1);
6274 val = XEXP (loc, 0);
6276 if (GET_CODE (val) == CONCAT)
6278 uloc = XEXP (val, 1);
6279 val = XEXP (val, 0);
6282 if (VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION (loc))
6283 val_resolve (out, val, vloc, insn);
6284 else
6285 val_store (out, val, uloc, insn, false);
6287 if (VAL_HOLDS_TRACK_EXPR (loc))
6289 if (GET_CODE (uloc) == REG)
6290 var_reg_set (out, uloc, VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED,
6291 NULL);
6292 else if (GET_CODE (uloc) == MEM)
6293 var_mem_set (out, uloc, VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED,
6294 NULL);
6297 break;
6299 case MO_VAL_SET:
6301 rtx loc = mo->u.loc;
6302 rtx val, vloc, uloc, reverse = NULL_RTX;
6304 vloc = loc;
6305 if (VAL_EXPR_HAS_REVERSE (loc))
6307 reverse = XEXP (loc, 1);
6308 vloc = XEXP (loc, 0);
6310 uloc = XEXP (vloc, 1);
6311 val = XEXP (vloc, 0);
6312 vloc = uloc;
6314 if (GET_CODE (val) == CONCAT)
6316 vloc = XEXP (val, 1);
6317 val = XEXP (val, 0);
6320 if (GET_CODE (vloc) == SET)
6322 rtx vsrc = SET_SRC (vloc);
6324 gcc_assert (val != vsrc);
6325 gcc_assert (vloc == uloc || VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION (loc));
6327 vloc = SET_DEST (vloc);
6329 if (VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION (loc))
6330 val_resolve (out, val, vsrc, insn);
6332 else if (VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION (loc))
6334 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (uloc) == SET
6335 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (uloc)) == REG);
6336 val_resolve (out, val, SET_SRC (uloc), insn);
6339 if (VAL_HOLDS_TRACK_EXPR (loc))
6341 if (VAL_EXPR_IS_CLOBBERED (loc))
6343 if (REG_P (uloc))
6344 var_reg_delete (out, uloc, true);
6345 else if (MEM_P (uloc))
6346 var_mem_delete (out, uloc, true);
6348 else
6350 bool copied_p = VAL_EXPR_IS_COPIED (loc);
6351 rtx set_src = NULL;
6352 enum var_init_status status = VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED;
6354 if (GET_CODE (uloc) == SET)
6356 set_src = SET_SRC (uloc);
6357 uloc = SET_DEST (uloc);
6360 if (copied_p)
6362 if (flag_var_tracking_uninit)
6364 status = find_src_status (in, set_src);
6366 if (status == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNKNOWN)
6367 status = find_src_status (out, set_src);
6370 set_src = find_src_set_src (in, set_src);
6373 if (REG_P (uloc))
6374 var_reg_delete_and_set (out, uloc, !copied_p,
6375 status, set_src);
6376 else if (MEM_P (uloc))
6377 var_mem_delete_and_set (out, uloc, !copied_p,
6378 status, set_src);
6381 else if (REG_P (uloc))
6382 var_regno_delete (out, REGNO (uloc));
6384 val_store (out, val, vloc, insn, true);
6386 if (reverse)
6387 val_store (out, XEXP (reverse, 0), XEXP (reverse, 1),
6388 insn, false);
6390 break;
6392 case MO_SET:
6394 rtx loc = mo->u.loc;
6395 rtx set_src = NULL;
6397 if (GET_CODE (loc) == SET)
6399 set_src = SET_SRC (loc);
6400 loc = SET_DEST (loc);
6403 if (REG_P (loc))
6404 var_reg_delete_and_set (out, loc, true, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED,
6405 set_src);
6406 else if (MEM_P (loc))
6407 var_mem_delete_and_set (out, loc, true, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED,
6408 set_src);
6410 break;
6412 case MO_COPY:
6414 rtx loc = mo->u.loc;
6415 enum var_init_status src_status;
6416 rtx set_src = NULL;
6418 if (GET_CODE (loc) == SET)
6420 set_src = SET_SRC (loc);
6421 loc = SET_DEST (loc);
6424 if (! flag_var_tracking_uninit)
6425 src_status = VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED;
6426 else
6428 src_status = find_src_status (in, set_src);
6430 if (src_status == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNKNOWN)
6431 src_status = find_src_status (out, set_src);
6434 set_src = find_src_set_src (in, set_src);
6436 if (REG_P (loc))
6437 var_reg_delete_and_set (out, loc, false, src_status, set_src);
6438 else if (MEM_P (loc))
6439 var_mem_delete_and_set (out, loc, false, src_status, set_src);
6441 break;
6443 case MO_USE_NO_VAR:
6445 rtx loc = mo->u.loc;
6447 if (REG_P (loc))
6448 var_reg_delete (out, loc, false);
6449 else if (MEM_P (loc))
6450 var_mem_delete (out, loc, false);
6452 break;
6454 case MO_CLOBBER:
6456 rtx loc = mo->u.loc;
6458 if (REG_P (loc))
6459 var_reg_delete (out, loc, true);
6460 else if (MEM_P (loc))
6461 var_mem_delete (out, loc, true);
6463 break;
6465 case MO_ADJUST:
6466 out->stack_adjust += mo->u.adjust;
6467 break;
6471 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_INSNS)
6473 dataflow_set_equiv_regs (out);
6474 htab_traverse (shared_hash_htab (out->vars), canonicalize_values_mark,
6475 out);
6476 htab_traverse (shared_hash_htab (out->vars), canonicalize_values_star,
6477 out);
6478 #if ENABLE_CHECKING
6479 htab_traverse (shared_hash_htab (out->vars),
6480 canonicalize_loc_order_check, out);
6481 #endif
6483 changed = dataflow_set_different (&old_out, out);
6484 dataflow_set_destroy (&old_out);
6485 return changed;
6488 /* Find the locations of variables in the whole function. */
6490 static bool
6491 vt_find_locations (void)
6493 fibheap_t worklist, pending, fibheap_swap;
6494 sbitmap visited, in_worklist, in_pending, sbitmap_swap;
6495 basic_block bb;
6496 edge e;
6497 int *bb_order;
6498 int *rc_order;
6499 int i;
6500 int htabsz = 0;
6501 int htabmax = PARAM_VALUE (PARAM_MAX_VARTRACK_SIZE);
6502 bool success = true;
6504 timevar_push (TV_VAR_TRACKING_DATAFLOW);
6505 /* Compute reverse completion order of depth first search of the CFG
6506 so that the data-flow runs faster. */
6507 rc_order = XNEWVEC (int, n_basic_blocks - NUM_FIXED_BLOCKS);
6508 bb_order = XNEWVEC (int, last_basic_block);
6509 pre_and_rev_post_order_compute (NULL, rc_order, false);
6510 for (i = 0; i < n_basic_blocks - NUM_FIXED_BLOCKS; i++)
6511 bb_order[rc_order[i]] = i;
6512 free (rc_order);
6514 worklist = fibheap_new ();
6515 pending = fibheap_new ();
6516 visited = sbitmap_alloc (last_basic_block);
6517 in_worklist = sbitmap_alloc (last_basic_block);
6518 in_pending = sbitmap_alloc (last_basic_block);
6519 sbitmap_zero (in_worklist);
6521 FOR_EACH_BB (bb)
6522 fibheap_insert (pending, bb_order[bb->index], bb);
6523 sbitmap_ones (in_pending);
6525 while (success && !fibheap_empty (pending))
6527 fibheap_swap = pending;
6528 pending = worklist;
6529 worklist = fibheap_swap;
6530 sbitmap_swap = in_pending;
6531 in_pending = in_worklist;
6532 in_worklist = sbitmap_swap;
6534 sbitmap_zero (visited);
6536 while (!fibheap_empty (worklist))
6538 bb = (basic_block) fibheap_extract_min (worklist);
6539 RESET_BIT (in_worklist, bb->index);
6540 gcc_assert (!TEST_BIT (visited, bb->index));
6541 if (!TEST_BIT (visited, bb->index))
6543 bool changed;
6544 edge_iterator ei;
6545 int oldinsz, oldoutsz;
6547 SET_BIT (visited, bb->index);
6549 if (VTI (bb)->in.vars)
6551 htabsz
6552 -= (htab_size (shared_hash_htab (VTI (bb)->in.vars))
6553 + htab_size (shared_hash_htab (VTI (bb)->out.vars)));
6554 oldinsz
6555 = htab_elements (shared_hash_htab (VTI (bb)->in.vars));
6556 oldoutsz
6557 = htab_elements (shared_hash_htab (VTI (bb)->out.vars));
6559 else
6560 oldinsz = oldoutsz = 0;
6562 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_INSNS)
6564 dataflow_set *in = &VTI (bb)->in, *first_out = NULL;
6565 bool first = true, adjust = false;
6567 /* Calculate the IN set as the intersection of
6568 predecessor OUT sets. */
6570 dataflow_set_clear (in);
6571 dst_can_be_shared = true;
6573 FOR_EACH_EDGE (e, ei, bb->preds)
6574 if (!VTI (e->src)->flooded)
6575 gcc_assert (bb_order[bb->index]
6576 <= bb_order[e->src->index]);
6577 else if (first)
6579 dataflow_set_copy (in, &VTI (e->src)->out);
6580 first_out = &VTI (e->src)->out;
6581 first = false;
6583 else
6585 dataflow_set_merge (in, &VTI (e->src)->out);
6586 adjust = true;
6589 if (adjust)
6591 dataflow_post_merge_adjust (in, &VTI (bb)->permp);
6592 #if ENABLE_CHECKING
6593 /* Merge and merge_adjust should keep entries in
6594 canonical order. */
6595 htab_traverse (shared_hash_htab (in->vars),
6596 canonicalize_loc_order_check,
6597 in);
6598 #endif
6599 if (dst_can_be_shared)
6601 shared_hash_destroy (in->vars);
6602 in->vars = shared_hash_copy (first_out->vars);
6606 VTI (bb)->flooded = true;
6608 else
6610 /* Calculate the IN set as union of predecessor OUT sets. */
6611 dataflow_set_clear (&VTI (bb)->in);
6612 FOR_EACH_EDGE (e, ei, bb->preds)
6613 dataflow_set_union (&VTI (bb)->in, &VTI (e->src)->out);
6616 changed = compute_bb_dataflow (bb);
6617 htabsz += (htab_size (shared_hash_htab (VTI (bb)->in.vars))
6618 + htab_size (shared_hash_htab (VTI (bb)->out.vars)));
6620 if (htabmax && htabsz > htabmax)
6622 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_INSNS)
6623 inform (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (cfun->decl),
6624 "variable tracking size limit exceeded with "
6625 "-fvar-tracking-assignments, retrying without");
6626 else
6627 inform (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (cfun->decl),
6628 "variable tracking size limit exceeded");
6629 success = false;
6630 break;
6633 if (changed)
6635 FOR_EACH_EDGE (e, ei, bb->succs)
6637 if (e->dest == EXIT_BLOCK_PTR)
6638 continue;
6640 if (TEST_BIT (visited, e->dest->index))
6642 if (!TEST_BIT (in_pending, e->dest->index))
6644 /* Send E->DEST to next round. */
6645 SET_BIT (in_pending, e->dest->index);
6646 fibheap_insert (pending,
6647 bb_order[e->dest->index],
6648 e->dest);
6651 else if (!TEST_BIT (in_worklist, e->dest->index))
6653 /* Add E->DEST to current round. */
6654 SET_BIT (in_worklist, e->dest->index);
6655 fibheap_insert (worklist, bb_order[e->dest->index],
6656 e->dest);
6661 if (dump_file)
6662 fprintf (dump_file,
6663 "BB %i: in %i (was %i), out %i (was %i), rem %i + %i, tsz %i\n",
6664 bb->index,
6665 (int)htab_elements (shared_hash_htab (VTI (bb)->in.vars)),
6666 oldinsz,
6667 (int)htab_elements (shared_hash_htab (VTI (bb)->out.vars)),
6668 oldoutsz,
6669 (int)worklist->nodes, (int)pending->nodes, htabsz);
6671 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
6673 fprintf (dump_file, "BB %i IN:\n", bb->index);
6674 dump_dataflow_set (&VTI (bb)->in);
6675 fprintf (dump_file, "BB %i OUT:\n", bb->index);
6676 dump_dataflow_set (&VTI (bb)->out);
6682 if (success && MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_INSNS)
6683 FOR_EACH_BB (bb)
6684 gcc_assert (VTI (bb)->flooded);
6686 free (bb_order);
6687 fibheap_delete (worklist);
6688 fibheap_delete (pending);
6689 sbitmap_free (visited);
6690 sbitmap_free (in_worklist);
6691 sbitmap_free (in_pending);
6693 timevar_pop (TV_VAR_TRACKING_DATAFLOW);
6694 return success;
6697 /* Print the content of the LIST to dump file. */
6699 static void
6700 dump_attrs_list (attrs list)
6702 for (; list; list = list->next)
6704 if (dv_is_decl_p (list->dv))
6705 print_mem_expr (dump_file, dv_as_decl (list->dv));
6706 else
6707 print_rtl_single (dump_file, dv_as_value (list->dv));
6708 fprintf (dump_file, "+" HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, list->offset);
6710 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
6713 /* Print the information about variable *SLOT to dump file. */
6715 static int
6716 dump_var_slot (void **slot, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
6718 variable var = (variable) *slot;
6720 dump_var (var);
6722 /* Continue traversing the hash table. */
6723 return 1;
6726 /* Print the information about variable VAR to dump file. */
6728 static void
6729 dump_var (variable var)
6731 int i;
6732 location_chain node;
6734 if (dv_is_decl_p (var->dv))
6736 const_tree decl = dv_as_decl (var->dv);
6738 if (DECL_NAME (decl))
6740 fprintf (dump_file, " name: %s",
6741 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (decl)));
6742 if (dump_flags & TDF_UID)
6743 fprintf (dump_file, "D.%u", DECL_UID (decl));
6745 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == DEBUG_EXPR_DECL)
6746 fprintf (dump_file, " name: D#%u", DEBUG_TEMP_UID (decl));
6747 else
6748 fprintf (dump_file, " name: D.%u", DECL_UID (decl));
6749 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
6751 else
6753 fputc (' ', dump_file);
6754 print_rtl_single (dump_file, dv_as_value (var->dv));
6757 for (i = 0; i < var->n_var_parts; i++)
6759 fprintf (dump_file, " offset %ld\n",
6760 (long)(var->onepart ? 0 : VAR_PART_OFFSET (var, i)));
6761 for (node = var->var_part[i].loc_chain; node; node = node->next)
6763 fprintf (dump_file, " ");
6764 if (node->init == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
6765 fprintf (dump_file, "[uninit]");
6766 print_rtl_single (dump_file, node->loc);
6771 /* Print the information about variables from hash table VARS to dump file. */
6773 static void
6774 dump_vars (htab_t vars)
6776 if (htab_elements (vars) > 0)
6778 fprintf (dump_file, "Variables:\n");
6779 htab_traverse (vars, dump_var_slot, NULL);
6783 /* Print the dataflow set SET to dump file. */
6785 static void
6786 dump_dataflow_set (dataflow_set *set)
6788 int i;
6790 fprintf (dump_file, "Stack adjustment: " HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC "\n",
6791 set->stack_adjust);
6792 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
6794 if (set->regs[i])
6796 fprintf (dump_file, "Reg %d:", i);
6797 dump_attrs_list (set->regs[i]);
6800 dump_vars (shared_hash_htab (set->vars));
6801 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
6804 /* Print the IN and OUT sets for each basic block to dump file. */
6806 static void
6807 dump_dataflow_sets (void)
6809 basic_block bb;
6811 FOR_EACH_BB (bb)
6813 fprintf (dump_file, "\nBasic block %d:\n", bb->index);
6814 fprintf (dump_file, "IN:\n");
6815 dump_dataflow_set (&VTI (bb)->in);
6816 fprintf (dump_file, "OUT:\n");
6817 dump_dataflow_set (&VTI (bb)->out);
6821 /* Return the variable for DV in dropped_values, inserting one if
6822 requested with INSERT. */
6824 static inline variable
6825 variable_from_dropped (decl_or_value dv, enum insert_option insert)
6827 void **slot;
6828 variable empty_var;
6829 onepart_enum_t onepart;
6831 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (dropped_values, dv, dv_htab_hash (dv),
6832 insert);
6834 if (!slot)
6835 return NULL;
6837 if (*slot)
6838 return (variable) *slot;
6840 gcc_checking_assert (insert == INSERT);
6842 onepart = dv_onepart_p (dv);
6844 gcc_checking_assert (onepart == ONEPART_VALUE || onepart == ONEPART_DEXPR);
6846 empty_var = (variable) pool_alloc (onepart_pool (onepart));
6847 empty_var->dv = dv;
6848 empty_var->refcount = 1;
6849 empty_var->n_var_parts = 0;
6850 empty_var->onepart = onepart;
6851 empty_var->in_changed_variables = false;
6852 empty_var->var_part[0].loc_chain = NULL;
6853 empty_var->var_part[0].cur_loc = NULL;
6854 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (empty_var) = NULL;
6855 set_dv_changed (dv, true);
6857 *slot = empty_var;
6859 return empty_var;
6862 /* Recover the one-part aux from dropped_values. */
6864 static struct onepart_aux *
6865 recover_dropped_1paux (variable var)
6867 variable dvar;
6869 gcc_checking_assert (var->onepart);
6871 if (VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var))
6872 return VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var);
6874 if (var->onepart == ONEPART_VDECL)
6875 return NULL;
6877 dvar = variable_from_dropped (var->dv, NO_INSERT);
6879 if (!dvar)
6880 return NULL;
6882 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var) = VAR_LOC_1PAUX (dvar);
6883 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (dvar) = NULL;
6885 return VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var);
6888 /* Add variable VAR to the hash table of changed variables and
6889 if it has no locations delete it from SET's hash table. */
6891 static void
6892 variable_was_changed (variable var, dataflow_set *set)
6894 hashval_t hash = dv_htab_hash (var->dv);
6896 if (emit_notes)
6898 void **slot;
6900 /* Remember this decl or VALUE has been added to changed_variables. */
6901 set_dv_changed (var->dv, true);
6903 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (changed_variables,
6904 var->dv,
6905 hash, INSERT);
6907 if (*slot)
6909 variable old_var = (variable) *slot;
6910 gcc_assert (old_var->in_changed_variables);
6911 old_var->in_changed_variables = false;
6912 if (var != old_var && var->onepart)
6914 /* Restore the auxiliary info from an empty variable
6915 previously created for changed_variables, so it is
6916 not lost. */
6917 gcc_checking_assert (!VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var));
6918 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var) = VAR_LOC_1PAUX (old_var);
6919 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (old_var) = NULL;
6921 variable_htab_free (*slot);
6924 if (set && var->n_var_parts == 0)
6926 onepart_enum_t onepart = var->onepart;
6927 variable empty_var = NULL;
6928 void **dslot = NULL;
6930 if (onepart == ONEPART_VALUE || onepart == ONEPART_DEXPR)
6932 dslot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (dropped_values, var->dv,
6933 dv_htab_hash (var->dv),
6934 INSERT);
6935 empty_var = (variable) *dslot;
6937 if (empty_var)
6939 gcc_checking_assert (!empty_var->in_changed_variables);
6940 if (!VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var))
6942 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var) = VAR_LOC_1PAUX (empty_var);
6943 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (empty_var) = NULL;
6945 else
6946 gcc_checking_assert (!VAR_LOC_1PAUX (empty_var));
6950 if (!empty_var)
6952 empty_var = (variable) pool_alloc (onepart_pool (onepart));
6953 empty_var->dv = var->dv;
6954 empty_var->refcount = 1;
6955 empty_var->n_var_parts = 0;
6956 empty_var->onepart = onepart;
6957 if (dslot)
6959 empty_var->refcount++;
6960 *dslot = empty_var;
6963 else
6964 empty_var->refcount++;
6965 empty_var->in_changed_variables = true;
6966 *slot = empty_var;
6967 if (onepart)
6969 empty_var->var_part[0].loc_chain = NULL;
6970 empty_var->var_part[0].cur_loc = NULL;
6971 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (empty_var) = VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var);
6972 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var) = NULL;
6974 goto drop_var;
6976 else
6978 if (var->onepart && !VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var))
6979 recover_dropped_1paux (var);
6980 var->refcount++;
6981 var->in_changed_variables = true;
6982 *slot = var;
6985 else
6987 gcc_assert (set);
6988 if (var->n_var_parts == 0)
6990 void **slot;
6992 drop_var:
6993 slot = shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert (set->vars, var->dv);
6994 if (slot)
6996 if (shared_hash_shared (set->vars))
6997 slot = shared_hash_find_slot_unshare (&set->vars, var->dv,
6998 NO_INSERT);
6999 htab_clear_slot (shared_hash_htab (set->vars), slot);
7005 /* Look for the index in VAR->var_part corresponding to OFFSET.
7006 Return -1 if not found. If INSERTION_POINT is non-NULL, the
7007 referenced int will be set to the index that the part has or should
7008 have, if it should be inserted. */
7010 static inline int
7011 find_variable_location_part (variable var, HOST_WIDE_INT offset,
7012 int *insertion_point)
7014 int pos, low, high;
7016 if (var->onepart)
7018 if (offset != 0)
7019 return -1;
7021 if (insertion_point)
7022 *insertion_point = 0;
7024 return var->n_var_parts - 1;
7027 /* Find the location part. */
7028 low = 0;
7029 high = var->n_var_parts;
7030 while (low != high)
7032 pos = (low + high) / 2;
7033 if (VAR_PART_OFFSET (var, pos) < offset)
7034 low = pos + 1;
7035 else
7036 high = pos;
7038 pos = low;
7040 if (insertion_point)
7041 *insertion_point = pos;
7043 if (pos < var->n_var_parts && VAR_PART_OFFSET (var, pos) == offset)
7044 return pos;
7046 return -1;
7049 static void **
7050 set_slot_part (dataflow_set *set, rtx loc, void **slot,
7051 decl_or_value dv, HOST_WIDE_INT offset,
7052 enum var_init_status initialized, rtx set_src)
7054 int pos;
7055 location_chain node, next;
7056 location_chain *nextp;
7057 variable var;
7058 onepart_enum_t onepart;
7060 var = (variable) *slot;
7062 if (var)
7063 onepart = var->onepart;
7064 else
7065 onepart = dv_onepart_p (dv);
7067 gcc_checking_assert (offset == 0 || !onepart);
7068 gcc_checking_assert (loc != dv_as_opaque (dv));
7070 if (! flag_var_tracking_uninit)
7071 initialized = VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED;
7073 if (!var)
7075 /* Create new variable information. */
7076 var = (variable) pool_alloc (onepart_pool (onepart));
7077 var->dv = dv;
7078 var->refcount = 1;
7079 var->n_var_parts = 1;
7080 var->onepart = onepart;
7081 var->in_changed_variables = false;
7082 if (var->onepart)
7083 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var) = NULL;
7084 else
7085 VAR_PART_OFFSET (var, 0) = offset;
7086 var->var_part[0].loc_chain = NULL;
7087 var->var_part[0].cur_loc = NULL;
7088 *slot = var;
7089 pos = 0;
7090 nextp = &var->var_part[0].loc_chain;
7092 else if (onepart)
7094 int r = -1, c = 0;
7096 gcc_assert (dv_as_opaque (var->dv) == dv_as_opaque (dv));
7098 pos = 0;
7100 if (GET_CODE (loc) == VALUE)
7102 for (nextp = &var->var_part[0].loc_chain; (node = *nextp);
7103 nextp = &node->next)
7104 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == VALUE)
7106 if (node->loc == loc)
7108 r = 0;
7109 break;
7111 if (canon_value_cmp (node->loc, loc))
7112 c++;
7113 else
7115 r = 1;
7116 break;
7119 else if (REG_P (node->loc) || MEM_P (node->loc))
7120 c++;
7121 else
7123 r = 1;
7124 break;
7127 else if (REG_P (loc))
7129 for (nextp = &var->var_part[0].loc_chain; (node = *nextp);
7130 nextp = &node->next)
7131 if (REG_P (node->loc))
7133 if (REGNO (node->loc) < REGNO (loc))
7134 c++;
7135 else
7137 if (REGNO (node->loc) == REGNO (loc))
7138 r = 0;
7139 else
7140 r = 1;
7141 break;
7144 else
7146 r = 1;
7147 break;
7150 else if (MEM_P (loc))
7152 for (nextp = &var->var_part[0].loc_chain; (node = *nextp);
7153 nextp = &node->next)
7154 if (REG_P (node->loc))
7155 c++;
7156 else if (MEM_P (node->loc))
7158 if ((r = loc_cmp (XEXP (node->loc, 0), XEXP (loc, 0))) >= 0)
7159 break;
7160 else
7161 c++;
7163 else
7165 r = 1;
7166 break;
7169 else
7170 for (nextp = &var->var_part[0].loc_chain; (node = *nextp);
7171 nextp = &node->next)
7172 if ((r = loc_cmp (node->loc, loc)) >= 0)
7173 break;
7174 else
7175 c++;
7177 if (r == 0)
7178 return slot;
7180 if (shared_var_p (var, set->vars))
7182 slot = unshare_variable (set, slot, var, initialized);
7183 var = (variable)*slot;
7184 for (nextp = &var->var_part[0].loc_chain; c;
7185 nextp = &(*nextp)->next)
7186 c--;
7187 gcc_assert ((!node && !*nextp) || node->loc == (*nextp)->loc);
7190 else
7192 int inspos = 0;
7194 gcc_assert (dv_as_decl (var->dv) == dv_as_decl (dv));
7196 pos = find_variable_location_part (var, offset, &inspos);
7198 if (pos >= 0)
7200 node = var->var_part[pos].loc_chain;
7202 if (node
7203 && ((REG_P (node->loc) && REG_P (loc)
7204 && REGNO (node->loc) == REGNO (loc))
7205 || rtx_equal_p (node->loc, loc)))
7207 /* LOC is in the beginning of the chain so we have nothing
7208 to do. */
7209 if (node->init < initialized)
7210 node->init = initialized;
7211 if (set_src != NULL)
7212 node->set_src = set_src;
7214 return slot;
7216 else
7218 /* We have to make a copy of a shared variable. */
7219 if (shared_var_p (var, set->vars))
7221 slot = unshare_variable (set, slot, var, initialized);
7222 var = (variable)*slot;
7226 else
7228 /* We have not found the location part, new one will be created. */
7230 /* We have to make a copy of the shared variable. */
7231 if (shared_var_p (var, set->vars))
7233 slot = unshare_variable (set, slot, var, initialized);
7234 var = (variable)*slot;
7237 /* We track only variables whose size is <= MAX_VAR_PARTS bytes
7238 thus there are at most MAX_VAR_PARTS different offsets. */
7239 gcc_assert (var->n_var_parts < MAX_VAR_PARTS
7240 && (!var->n_var_parts || !onepart));
7242 /* We have to move the elements of array starting at index
7243 inspos to the next position. */
7244 for (pos = var->n_var_parts; pos > inspos; pos--)
7245 var->var_part[pos] = var->var_part[pos - 1];
7247 var->n_var_parts++;
7248 gcc_checking_assert (!onepart);
7249 VAR_PART_OFFSET (var, pos) = offset;
7250 var->var_part[pos].loc_chain = NULL;
7251 var->var_part[pos].cur_loc = NULL;
7254 /* Delete the location from the list. */
7255 nextp = &var->var_part[pos].loc_chain;
7256 for (node = var->var_part[pos].loc_chain; node; node = next)
7258 next = node->next;
7259 if ((REG_P (node->loc) && REG_P (loc)
7260 && REGNO (node->loc) == REGNO (loc))
7261 || rtx_equal_p (node->loc, loc))
7263 /* Save these values, to assign to the new node, before
7264 deleting this one. */
7265 if (node->init > initialized)
7266 initialized = node->init;
7267 if (node->set_src != NULL && set_src == NULL)
7268 set_src = node->set_src;
7269 if (var->var_part[pos].cur_loc == node->loc)
7270 var->var_part[pos].cur_loc = NULL;
7271 pool_free (loc_chain_pool, node);
7272 *nextp = next;
7273 break;
7275 else
7276 nextp = &node->next;
7279 nextp = &var->var_part[pos].loc_chain;
7282 /* Add the location to the beginning. */
7283 node = (location_chain) pool_alloc (loc_chain_pool);
7284 node->loc = loc;
7285 node->init = initialized;
7286 node->set_src = set_src;
7287 node->next = *nextp;
7288 *nextp = node;
7290 /* If no location was emitted do so. */
7291 if (var->var_part[pos].cur_loc == NULL)
7292 variable_was_changed (var, set);
7294 return slot;
7297 /* Set the part of variable's location in the dataflow set SET. The
7298 variable part is specified by variable's declaration in DV and
7299 offset OFFSET and the part's location by LOC. IOPT should be
7300 NO_INSERT if the variable is known to be in SET already and the
7301 variable hash table must not be resized, and INSERT otherwise. */
7303 static void
7304 set_variable_part (dataflow_set *set, rtx loc,
7305 decl_or_value dv, HOST_WIDE_INT offset,
7306 enum var_init_status initialized, rtx set_src,
7307 enum insert_option iopt)
7309 void **slot;
7311 if (iopt == NO_INSERT)
7312 slot = shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert (set->vars, dv);
7313 else
7315 slot = shared_hash_find_slot (set->vars, dv);
7316 if (!slot)
7317 slot = shared_hash_find_slot_unshare (&set->vars, dv, iopt);
7319 set_slot_part (set, loc, slot, dv, offset, initialized, set_src);
7322 /* Remove all recorded register locations for the given variable part
7323 from dataflow set SET, except for those that are identical to loc.
7324 The variable part is specified by variable's declaration or value
7325 DV and offset OFFSET. */
7327 static void **
7328 clobber_slot_part (dataflow_set *set, rtx loc, void **slot,
7329 HOST_WIDE_INT offset, rtx set_src)
7331 variable var = (variable) *slot;
7332 int pos = find_variable_location_part (var, offset, NULL);
7334 if (pos >= 0)
7336 location_chain node, next;
7338 /* Remove the register locations from the dataflow set. */
7339 next = var->var_part[pos].loc_chain;
7340 for (node = next; node; node = next)
7342 next = node->next;
7343 if (node->loc != loc
7344 && (!flag_var_tracking_uninit
7345 || !set_src
7346 || MEM_P (set_src)
7347 || !rtx_equal_p (set_src, node->set_src)))
7349 if (REG_P (node->loc))
7351 attrs anode, anext;
7352 attrs *anextp;
7354 /* Remove the variable part from the register's
7355 list, but preserve any other variable parts
7356 that might be regarded as live in that same
7357 register. */
7358 anextp = &set->regs[REGNO (node->loc)];
7359 for (anode = *anextp; anode; anode = anext)
7361 anext = anode->next;
7362 if (dv_as_opaque (anode->dv) == dv_as_opaque (var->dv)
7363 && anode->offset == offset)
7365 pool_free (attrs_pool, anode);
7366 *anextp = anext;
7368 else
7369 anextp = &anode->next;
7373 slot = delete_slot_part (set, node->loc, slot, offset);
7378 return slot;
7381 /* Remove all recorded register locations for the given variable part
7382 from dataflow set SET, except for those that are identical to loc.
7383 The variable part is specified by variable's declaration or value
7384 DV and offset OFFSET. */
7386 static void
7387 clobber_variable_part (dataflow_set *set, rtx loc, decl_or_value dv,
7388 HOST_WIDE_INT offset, rtx set_src)
7390 void **slot;
7392 if (!dv_as_opaque (dv)
7393 || (!dv_is_value_p (dv) && ! DECL_P (dv_as_decl (dv))))
7394 return;
7396 slot = shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert (set->vars, dv);
7397 if (!slot)
7398 return;
7400 clobber_slot_part (set, loc, slot, offset, set_src);
7403 /* Delete the part of variable's location from dataflow set SET. The
7404 variable part is specified by its SET->vars slot SLOT and offset
7405 OFFSET and the part's location by LOC. */
7407 static void **
7408 delete_slot_part (dataflow_set *set, rtx loc, void **slot,
7409 HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
7411 variable var = (variable) *slot;
7412 int pos = find_variable_location_part (var, offset, NULL);
7414 if (pos >= 0)
7416 location_chain node, next;
7417 location_chain *nextp;
7418 bool changed;
7419 rtx cur_loc;
7421 if (shared_var_p (var, set->vars))
7423 /* If the variable contains the location part we have to
7424 make a copy of the variable. */
7425 for (node = var->var_part[pos].loc_chain; node;
7426 node = node->next)
7428 if ((REG_P (node->loc) && REG_P (loc)
7429 && REGNO (node->loc) == REGNO (loc))
7430 || rtx_equal_p (node->loc, loc))
7432 slot = unshare_variable (set, slot, var,
7433 VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNKNOWN);
7434 var = (variable)*slot;
7435 break;
7440 if (pos == 0 && var->onepart && VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var))
7441 cur_loc = VAR_LOC_FROM (var);
7442 else
7443 cur_loc = var->var_part[pos].cur_loc;
7445 /* Delete the location part. */
7446 changed = false;
7447 nextp = &var->var_part[pos].loc_chain;
7448 for (node = *nextp; node; node = next)
7450 next = node->next;
7451 if ((REG_P (node->loc) && REG_P (loc)
7452 && REGNO (node->loc) == REGNO (loc))
7453 || rtx_equal_p (node->loc, loc))
7455 /* If we have deleted the location which was last emitted
7456 we have to emit new location so add the variable to set
7457 of changed variables. */
7458 if (cur_loc == node->loc)
7460 changed = true;
7461 var->var_part[pos].cur_loc = NULL;
7462 if (pos == 0 && var->onepart && VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var))
7463 VAR_LOC_FROM (var) = NULL;
7465 pool_free (loc_chain_pool, node);
7466 *nextp = next;
7467 break;
7469 else
7470 nextp = &node->next;
7473 if (var->var_part[pos].loc_chain == NULL)
7475 changed = true;
7476 var->n_var_parts--;
7477 while (pos < var->n_var_parts)
7479 var->var_part[pos] = var->var_part[pos + 1];
7480 pos++;
7483 if (changed)
7484 variable_was_changed (var, set);
7487 return slot;
7490 /* Delete the part of variable's location from dataflow set SET. The
7491 variable part is specified by variable's declaration or value DV
7492 and offset OFFSET and the part's location by LOC. */
7494 static void
7495 delete_variable_part (dataflow_set *set, rtx loc, decl_or_value dv,
7496 HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
7498 void **slot = shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert (set->vars, dv);
7499 if (!slot)
7500 return;
7502 delete_slot_part (set, loc, slot, offset);
7505 DEF_VEC_P (variable);
7506 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_P (variable, heap);
7508 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_P_STACK (rtx);
7509 #define VEC_rtx_stack_alloc(alloc) VEC_stack_alloc (rtx, alloc)
7511 /* Structure for passing some other parameters to function
7512 vt_expand_loc_callback. */
7513 struct expand_loc_callback_data
7515 /* The variables and values active at this point. */
7516 htab_t vars;
7518 /* Stack of values and debug_exprs under expansion, and their
7519 children. */
7520 VEC (rtx, stack) *expanding;
7522 /* Stack of values and debug_exprs whose expansion hit recursion
7523 cycles. They will have VALUE_RECURSED_INTO marked when added to
7524 this list. This flag will be cleared if any of its dependencies
7525 resolves to a valid location. So, if the flag remains set at the
7526 end of the search, we know no valid location for this one can
7527 possibly exist. */
7528 VEC (rtx, stack) *pending;
7530 /* The maximum depth among the sub-expressions under expansion.
7531 Zero indicates no expansion so far. */
7532 int depth;
7535 /* Allocate the one-part auxiliary data structure for VAR, with enough
7536 room for COUNT dependencies. */
7538 static void
7539 loc_exp_dep_alloc (variable var, int count)
7541 size_t allocsize;
7543 gcc_checking_assert (var->onepart);
7545 /* We can be called with COUNT == 0 to allocate the data structure
7546 without any dependencies, e.g. for the backlinks only. However,
7547 if we are specifying a COUNT, then the dependency list must have
7548 been emptied before. It would be possible to adjust pointers or
7549 force it empty here, but this is better done at an earlier point
7550 in the algorithm, so we instead leave an assertion to catch
7551 errors. */
7552 gcc_checking_assert (!count
7553 || VEC_empty (loc_exp_dep, VAR_LOC_DEP_VEC (var)));
7555 if (VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var)
7556 && VEC_space (loc_exp_dep, VAR_LOC_DEP_VEC (var), count))
7557 return;
7559 allocsize = offsetof (struct onepart_aux, deps)
7560 + VEC_embedded_size (loc_exp_dep, count);
7562 if (VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var))
7564 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var) = XRESIZEVAR (struct onepart_aux,
7565 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var), allocsize);
7566 /* If the reallocation moves the onepaux structure, the
7567 back-pointer to BACKLINKS in the first list member will still
7568 point to its old location. Adjust it. */
7569 if (VAR_LOC_DEP_LST (var))
7570 VAR_LOC_DEP_LST (var)->pprev = VAR_LOC_DEP_LSTP (var);
7572 else
7574 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var) = XNEWVAR (struct onepart_aux, allocsize);
7575 *VAR_LOC_DEP_LSTP (var) = NULL;
7576 VAR_LOC_FROM (var) = NULL;
7577 VAR_LOC_DEPTH (var) = 0;
7579 VEC_embedded_init (loc_exp_dep, VAR_LOC_DEP_VEC (var), count);
7582 /* Remove all entries from the vector of active dependencies of VAR,
7583 removing them from the back-links lists too. */
7585 static void
7586 loc_exp_dep_clear (variable var)
7588 while (!VEC_empty (loc_exp_dep, VAR_LOC_DEP_VEC (var)))
7590 loc_exp_dep *led = VEC_last (loc_exp_dep, VAR_LOC_DEP_VEC (var));
7591 if (led->next)
7592 led->next->pprev = led->pprev;
7593 if (led->pprev)
7594 *led->pprev = led->next;
7595 VEC_pop (loc_exp_dep, VAR_LOC_DEP_VEC (var));
7599 /* Insert an active dependency from VAR on X to the vector of
7600 dependencies, and add the corresponding back-link to X's list of
7601 back-links in VARS. */
7603 static void
7604 loc_exp_insert_dep (variable var, rtx x, htab_t vars)
7606 decl_or_value dv;
7607 variable xvar;
7608 loc_exp_dep *led;
7610 dv = dv_from_rtx (x);
7612 /* ??? Build a vector of variables parallel to EXPANDING, to avoid
7613 an additional look up? */
7614 xvar = (variable) htab_find_with_hash (vars, dv, dv_htab_hash (dv));
7616 if (!xvar)
7618 xvar = variable_from_dropped (dv, NO_INSERT);
7619 gcc_checking_assert (xvar);
7622 /* No point in adding the same backlink more than once. This may
7623 arise if say the same value appears in two complex expressions in
7624 the same loc_list, or even more than once in a single
7625 expression. */
7626 if (VAR_LOC_DEP_LST (xvar) && VAR_LOC_DEP_LST (xvar)->dv == var->dv)
7627 return;
7629 VEC_quick_push (loc_exp_dep, VAR_LOC_DEP_VEC (var), NULL);
7630 led = VEC_last (loc_exp_dep, VAR_LOC_DEP_VEC (var));
7631 led->dv = var->dv;
7632 led->value = x;
7634 loc_exp_dep_alloc (xvar, 0);
7635 led->pprev = VAR_LOC_DEP_LSTP (xvar);
7636 led->next = *led->pprev;
7637 if (led->next)
7638 led->next->pprev = &led->next;
7639 *led->pprev = led;
7642 /* Create active dependencies of VAR on COUNT values starting at
7643 VALUE, and corresponding back-links to the entries in VARS. Return
7644 true if we found any pending-recursion results. */
7646 static bool
7647 loc_exp_dep_set (variable var, rtx result, rtx *value, int count, htab_t vars)
7649 bool pending_recursion = false;
7651 gcc_checking_assert (VEC_empty (loc_exp_dep, VAR_LOC_DEP_VEC (var)));
7653 /* Set up all dependencies from last_child (as set up at the end of
7654 the loop above) to the end. */
7655 loc_exp_dep_alloc (var, count);
7657 while (count--)
7659 rtx x = *value++;
7661 if (!pending_recursion)
7662 pending_recursion = !result && VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (x);
7664 loc_exp_insert_dep (var, x, vars);
7667 return pending_recursion;
7670 /* Notify the back-links of IVAR that are pending recursion that we
7671 have found a non-NIL value for it, so they are cleared for another
7672 attempt to compute a current location. */
7674 static void
7675 notify_dependents_of_resolved_value (variable ivar, htab_t vars)
7677 loc_exp_dep *led, *next;
7679 for (led = VAR_LOC_DEP_LST (ivar); led; led = next)
7681 decl_or_value dv = led->dv;
7682 variable var;
7684 next = led->next;
7686 if (dv_is_value_p (dv))
7688 rtx value = dv_as_value (dv);
7690 /* If we have already resolved it, leave it alone. */
7691 if (!VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (value))
7692 continue;
7694 /* Check that VALUE_RECURSED_INTO, true from the test above,
7695 implies NO_LOC_P. */
7696 gcc_checking_assert (NO_LOC_P (value));
7698 /* We won't notify variables that are being expanded,
7699 because their dependency list is cleared before
7700 recursing. */
7701 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (value) = false;
7703 gcc_checking_assert (dv_changed_p (dv));
7705 else if (!dv_changed_p (dv))
7706 continue;
7708 var = (variable) htab_find_with_hash (vars, dv, dv_htab_hash (dv));
7710 if (!var)
7711 var = variable_from_dropped (dv, NO_INSERT);
7713 if (var)
7714 notify_dependents_of_resolved_value (var, vars);
7716 if (next)
7717 next->pprev = led->pprev;
7718 if (led->pprev)
7719 *led->pprev = next;
7720 led->next = NULL;
7721 led->pprev = NULL;
7725 static rtx vt_expand_loc_callback (rtx x, bitmap regs,
7726 int max_depth, void *data);
7728 /* Return the combined depth, when one sub-expression evaluated to
7729 BEST_DEPTH and the previous known depth was SAVED_DEPTH. */
7731 static inline int
7732 update_depth (int saved_depth, int best_depth)
7734 /* If we didn't find anything, stick with what we had. */
7735 if (!best_depth)
7736 return saved_depth;
7738 /* If we found hadn't found anything, use the depth of the current
7739 expression. Do NOT add one extra level, we want to compute the
7740 maximum depth among sub-expressions. We'll increment it later,
7741 if appropriate. */
7742 if (!saved_depth)
7743 return best_depth;
7745 if (saved_depth < best_depth)
7746 return best_depth;
7747 else
7748 return saved_depth;
7751 /* Expand VAR to a location RTX, updating its cur_loc. Use REGS and
7752 DATA for cselib expand callback. If PENDRECP is given, indicate in
7753 it whether any sub-expression couldn't be fully evaluated because
7754 it is pending recursion resolution. */
7756 static inline rtx
7757 vt_expand_var_loc_chain (variable var, bitmap regs, void *data, bool *pendrecp)
7759 struct expand_loc_callback_data *elcd
7760 = (struct expand_loc_callback_data *) data;
7761 location_chain loc, next;
7762 rtx result = NULL;
7763 int first_child, result_first_child, last_child;
7764 bool pending_recursion;
7765 rtx loc_from = NULL;
7766 struct elt_loc_list *cloc = NULL;
7767 int depth = 0, saved_depth = elcd->depth;
7769 /* Clear all backlinks pointing at this, so that we're not notified
7770 while we're active. */
7771 loc_exp_dep_clear (var);
7773 if (var->onepart == ONEPART_VALUE)
7775 cselib_val *val = CSELIB_VAL_PTR (dv_as_value (var->dv));
7777 gcc_checking_assert (cselib_preserved_value_p (val));
7779 cloc = val->locs;
7782 first_child = result_first_child = last_child
7783 = VEC_length (rtx, elcd->expanding);
7785 /* Attempt to expand each available location in turn. */
7786 for (next = loc = var->n_var_parts ? var->var_part[0].loc_chain : NULL;
7787 loc || cloc; loc = next)
7789 result_first_child = last_child;
7791 if (!loc || (GET_CODE (loc->loc) == ENTRY_VALUE && cloc))
7793 loc_from = cloc->loc;
7794 next = loc;
7795 cloc = cloc->next;
7796 if (unsuitable_loc (loc_from))
7797 continue;
7799 else
7801 loc_from = loc->loc;
7802 next = loc->next;
7805 gcc_checking_assert (!unsuitable_loc (loc_from));
7807 elcd->depth = 0;
7808 result = cselib_expand_value_rtx_cb (loc_from, regs, EXPR_DEPTH,
7809 vt_expand_loc_callback, data);
7810 last_child = VEC_length (rtx, elcd->expanding);
7812 if (result)
7814 depth = elcd->depth;
7816 gcc_checking_assert (depth || result_first_child == last_child);
7818 if (last_child - result_first_child != 1)
7819 depth++;
7821 if (depth <= EXPR_USE_DEPTH)
7822 break;
7824 result = NULL;
7827 /* Set it up in case we leave the loop. */
7828 depth = 0;
7829 loc_from = NULL;
7830 result_first_child = first_child;
7833 /* Register all encountered dependencies as active. */
7834 pending_recursion = loc_exp_dep_set
7835 (var, result, VEC_address (rtx, elcd->expanding) + result_first_child,
7836 last_child - result_first_child, elcd->vars);
7838 VEC_truncate (rtx, elcd->expanding, first_child);
7840 /* Record where the expansion came from. */
7841 gcc_checking_assert (!result || !pending_recursion);
7842 VAR_LOC_FROM (var) = loc_from;
7843 VAR_LOC_DEPTH (var) = depth;
7845 gcc_checking_assert (!depth == !result);
7847 elcd->depth = update_depth (saved_depth, depth);
7849 /* Indicate whether any of the dependencies are pending recursion
7850 resolution. */
7851 if (pendrecp)
7852 *pendrecp = pending_recursion;
7854 if (!pendrecp || !pending_recursion)
7855 var->var_part[0].cur_loc = result;
7857 return result;
7860 /* Callback for cselib_expand_value, that looks for expressions
7861 holding the value in the var-tracking hash tables. Return X for
7862 standard processing, anything else is to be used as-is. */
7864 static rtx
7865 vt_expand_loc_callback (rtx x, bitmap regs,
7866 int max_depth ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7867 void *data)
7869 struct expand_loc_callback_data *elcd
7870 = (struct expand_loc_callback_data *) data;
7871 decl_or_value dv;
7872 variable var;
7873 rtx result, subreg;
7874 bool pending_recursion = false;
7875 bool from_empty = false;
7877 switch (GET_CODE (x))
7879 case SUBREG:
7880 subreg = cselib_expand_value_rtx_cb (SUBREG_REG (x), regs,
7881 EXPR_DEPTH,
7882 vt_expand_loc_callback, data);
7884 if (!subreg)
7885 return NULL;
7887 result = simplify_gen_subreg (GET_MODE (x), subreg,
7888 GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x)),
7889 SUBREG_BYTE (x));
7891 /* Invalid SUBREGs are ok in debug info. ??? We could try
7892 alternate expansions for the VALUE as well. */
7893 if (!result)
7894 result = gen_rtx_raw_SUBREG (GET_MODE (x), subreg, SUBREG_BYTE (x));
7896 return result;
7898 case DEBUG_EXPR:
7899 case VALUE:
7900 dv = dv_from_rtx (x);
7901 break;
7903 default:
7904 return x;
7907 VEC_safe_push (rtx, stack, elcd->expanding, x);
7909 /* Check that VALUE_RECURSED_INTO implies NO_LOC_P. */
7910 gcc_checking_assert (!VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (x) || NO_LOC_P (x));
7912 if (NO_LOC_P (x))
7913 return NULL;
7915 var = (variable) htab_find_with_hash (elcd->vars, dv, dv_htab_hash (dv));
7917 if (!var)
7919 from_empty = true;
7920 var = variable_from_dropped (dv, INSERT);
7923 gcc_checking_assert (var);
7925 if (!dv_changed_p (dv))
7927 gcc_checking_assert (!NO_LOC_P (x));
7928 gcc_checking_assert (var->var_part[0].cur_loc);
7929 gcc_checking_assert (VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var));
7930 gcc_checking_assert (VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var)->depth);
7932 elcd->depth = update_depth (elcd->depth, VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var)->depth);
7934 return var->var_part[0].cur_loc;
7937 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (x) = true;
7938 /* This is tentative, but it makes some tests simpler. */
7939 NO_LOC_P (x) = true;
7941 gcc_checking_assert (var->n_var_parts == 1 || from_empty);
7943 result = vt_expand_var_loc_chain (var, regs, data, &pending_recursion);
7945 if (pending_recursion)
7947 gcc_checking_assert (!result);
7948 VEC_safe_push (rtx, stack, elcd->pending, x);
7950 else
7952 NO_LOC_P (x) = !result;
7953 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (x) = false;
7954 set_dv_changed (dv, false);
7956 if (result)
7957 notify_dependents_of_resolved_value (var, elcd->vars);
7960 return result;
7963 /* While expanding variables, we may encounter recursion cycles
7964 because of mutual (possibly indirect) dependencies between two
7965 particular variables (or values), say A and B. If we're trying to
7966 expand A when we get to B, which in turn attempts to expand A, if
7967 we can't find any other expansion for B, we'll add B to this
7968 pending-recursion stack, and tentatively return NULL for its
7969 location. This tentative value will be used for any other
7970 occurrences of B, unless A gets some other location, in which case
7971 it will notify B that it is worth another try at computing a
7972 location for it, and it will use the location computed for A then.
7973 At the end of the expansion, the tentative NULL locations become
7974 final for all members of PENDING that didn't get a notification.
7975 This function performs this finalization of NULL locations. */
7977 static void
7978 resolve_expansions_pending_recursion (VEC (rtx, stack) *pending)
7980 while (!VEC_empty (rtx, pending))
7982 rtx x = VEC_pop (rtx, pending);
7983 decl_or_value dv;
7985 if (!VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (x))
7986 continue;
7988 gcc_checking_assert (NO_LOC_P (x));
7989 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (x) = false;
7990 dv = dv_from_rtx (x);
7991 gcc_checking_assert (dv_changed_p (dv));
7992 set_dv_changed (dv, false);
7996 /* Initialize expand_loc_callback_data D with variable hash table V.
7997 It must be a macro because of alloca (VEC stack). */
7998 #define INIT_ELCD(d, v) \
7999 do \
8001 (d).vars = (v); \
8002 (d).expanding = VEC_alloc (rtx, stack, 4); \
8003 (d).pending = VEC_alloc (rtx, stack, 4); \
8004 (d).depth = 0; \
8006 while (0)
8007 /* Finalize expand_loc_callback_data D, resolved to location L. */
8008 #define FINI_ELCD(d, l) \
8009 do \
8011 resolve_expansions_pending_recursion ((d).pending); \
8012 VEC_free (rtx, stack, (d).pending); \
8013 VEC_free (rtx, stack, (d).expanding); \
8015 if ((l) && MEM_P (l)) \
8016 (l) = targetm.delegitimize_address (l); \
8018 while (0)
8020 /* Expand VALUEs and DEBUG_EXPRs in LOC to a location, using the
8021 equivalences in VARS, updating their CUR_LOCs in the process. */
8023 static rtx
8024 vt_expand_loc (rtx loc, htab_t vars)
8026 struct expand_loc_callback_data data;
8027 rtx result;
8029 if (!MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_INSNS)
8030 return loc;
8032 INIT_ELCD (data, vars);
8034 result = cselib_expand_value_rtx_cb (loc, scratch_regs, EXPR_DEPTH,
8035 vt_expand_loc_callback, &data);
8037 FINI_ELCD (data, result);
8039 return result;
8042 /* Expand the one-part VARiable to a location, using the equivalences
8043 in VARS, updating their CUR_LOCs in the process. */
8045 static rtx
8046 vt_expand_1pvar (variable var, htab_t vars)
8048 struct expand_loc_callback_data data;
8049 rtx loc;
8051 gcc_checking_assert (var->onepart && var->n_var_parts == 1);
8053 if (!dv_changed_p (var->dv))
8054 return var->var_part[0].cur_loc;
8056 INIT_ELCD (data, vars);
8058 loc = vt_expand_var_loc_chain (var, scratch_regs, &data, NULL);
8060 gcc_checking_assert (VEC_empty (rtx, data.expanding));
8062 FINI_ELCD (data, loc);
8064 return loc;
8067 /* Emit the NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION for variable *VARP. DATA contains
8068 additional parameters: WHERE specifies whether the note shall be emitted
8069 before or after instruction INSN. */
8071 static int
8072 emit_note_insn_var_location (void **varp, void *data)
8074 variable var = (variable) *varp;
8075 rtx insn = ((emit_note_data *)data)->insn;
8076 enum emit_note_where where = ((emit_note_data *)data)->where;
8077 htab_t vars = ((emit_note_data *)data)->vars;
8078 rtx note, note_vl;
8079 int i, j, n_var_parts;
8080 bool complete;
8081 enum var_init_status initialized = VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED;
8082 HOST_WIDE_INT last_limit;
8083 tree type_size_unit;
8084 HOST_WIDE_INT offsets[MAX_VAR_PARTS];
8085 rtx loc[MAX_VAR_PARTS];
8086 tree decl;
8087 location_chain lc;
8089 gcc_checking_assert (var->onepart == NOT_ONEPART
8090 || var->onepart == ONEPART_VDECL);
8092 decl = dv_as_decl (var->dv);
8094 complete = true;
8095 last_limit = 0;
8096 n_var_parts = 0;
8097 if (!var->onepart)
8098 for (i = 0; i < var->n_var_parts; i++)
8099 if (var->var_part[i].cur_loc == NULL && var->var_part[i].loc_chain)
8100 var->var_part[i].cur_loc = var->var_part[i].loc_chain->loc;
8101 for (i = 0; i < var->n_var_parts; i++)
8103 enum machine_mode mode, wider_mode;
8104 rtx loc2;
8105 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
8107 if (i == 0 && var->onepart)
8109 gcc_checking_assert (var->n_var_parts == 1);
8110 offset = 0;
8111 initialized = VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED;
8112 loc2 = vt_expand_1pvar (var, vars);
8114 else
8116 if (last_limit < VAR_PART_OFFSET (var, i))
8118 complete = false;
8119 break;
8121 else if (last_limit > VAR_PART_OFFSET (var, i))
8122 continue;
8123 offset = VAR_PART_OFFSET (var, i);
8124 if (!var->var_part[i].cur_loc)
8126 complete = false;
8127 continue;
8129 for (lc = var->var_part[i].loc_chain; lc; lc = lc->next)
8130 if (var->var_part[i].cur_loc == lc->loc)
8132 initialized = lc->init;
8133 break;
8135 gcc_assert (lc);
8136 loc2 = var->var_part[i].cur_loc;
8139 offsets[n_var_parts] = offset;
8140 if (!loc2)
8142 complete = false;
8143 continue;
8145 loc[n_var_parts] = loc2;
8146 mode = GET_MODE (var->var_part[i].cur_loc);
8147 if (mode == VOIDmode && var->onepart)
8148 mode = DECL_MODE (decl);
8149 last_limit = offsets[n_var_parts] + GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
8151 /* Attempt to merge adjacent registers or memory. */
8152 wider_mode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (mode);
8153 for (j = i + 1; j < var->n_var_parts; j++)
8154 if (last_limit <= VAR_PART_OFFSET (var, j))
8155 break;
8156 if (j < var->n_var_parts
8157 && wider_mode != VOIDmode
8158 && var->var_part[j].cur_loc
8159 && mode == GET_MODE (var->var_part[j].cur_loc)
8160 && (REG_P (loc[n_var_parts]) || MEM_P (loc[n_var_parts]))
8161 && last_limit == (var->onepart ? 0 : VAR_PART_OFFSET (var, j))
8162 && (loc2 = vt_expand_loc (var->var_part[j].cur_loc, vars))
8163 && GET_CODE (loc[n_var_parts]) == GET_CODE (loc2))
8165 rtx new_loc = NULL;
8167 if (REG_P (loc[n_var_parts])
8168 && hard_regno_nregs[REGNO (loc[n_var_parts])][mode] * 2
8169 == hard_regno_nregs[REGNO (loc[n_var_parts])][wider_mode]
8170 && end_hard_regno (mode, REGNO (loc[n_var_parts]))
8171 == REGNO (loc2))
8173 if (! WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN && ! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
8174 new_loc = simplify_subreg (wider_mode, loc[n_var_parts],
8175 mode, 0);
8176 else if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
8177 new_loc = simplify_subreg (wider_mode, loc2, mode, 0);
8178 if (new_loc)
8180 if (!REG_P (new_loc)
8181 || REGNO (new_loc) != REGNO (loc[n_var_parts]))
8182 new_loc = NULL;
8183 else
8184 REG_ATTRS (new_loc) = REG_ATTRS (loc[n_var_parts]);
8187 else if (MEM_P (loc[n_var_parts])
8188 && GET_CODE (XEXP (loc2, 0)) == PLUS
8189 && REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (loc2, 0), 0))
8190 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (XEXP (loc2, 0), 1)))
8192 if ((REG_P (XEXP (loc[n_var_parts], 0))
8193 && rtx_equal_p (XEXP (loc[n_var_parts], 0),
8194 XEXP (XEXP (loc2, 0), 0))
8195 && INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (loc2, 0), 1))
8196 == GET_MODE_SIZE (mode))
8197 || (GET_CODE (XEXP (loc[n_var_parts], 0)) == PLUS
8198 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (XEXP (loc[n_var_parts], 0), 1))
8199 && rtx_equal_p (XEXP (XEXP (loc[n_var_parts], 0), 0),
8200 XEXP (XEXP (loc2, 0), 0))
8201 && INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (loc[n_var_parts], 0), 1))
8202 + GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)
8203 == INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (loc2, 0), 1))))
8204 new_loc = adjust_address_nv (loc[n_var_parts],
8205 wider_mode, 0);
8208 if (new_loc)
8210 loc[n_var_parts] = new_loc;
8211 mode = wider_mode;
8212 last_limit = offsets[n_var_parts] + GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
8213 i = j;
8216 ++n_var_parts;
8218 type_size_unit = TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (TREE_TYPE (decl));
8219 if ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) last_limit < TREE_INT_CST_LOW (type_size_unit))
8220 complete = false;
8222 if (! flag_var_tracking_uninit)
8223 initialized = VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED;
8225 note_vl = NULL_RTX;
8226 if (!complete)
8227 note_vl = gen_rtx_VAR_LOCATION (VOIDmode, decl, NULL_RTX,
8228 (int) initialized);
8229 else if (n_var_parts == 1)
8231 rtx expr_list;
8233 if (offsets[0] || GET_CODE (loc[0]) == PARALLEL)
8234 expr_list = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, loc[0], GEN_INT (offsets[0]));
8235 else
8236 expr_list = loc[0];
8238 note_vl = gen_rtx_VAR_LOCATION (VOIDmode, decl, expr_list,
8239 (int) initialized);
8241 else if (n_var_parts)
8243 rtx parallel;
8245 for (i = 0; i < n_var_parts; i++)
8246 loc[i]
8247 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, loc[i], GEN_INT (offsets[i]));
8249 parallel = gen_rtx_PARALLEL (VOIDmode,
8250 gen_rtvec_v (n_var_parts, loc));
8251 note_vl = gen_rtx_VAR_LOCATION (VOIDmode, decl,
8252 parallel, (int) initialized);
8255 if (where != EMIT_NOTE_BEFORE_INSN)
8257 note = emit_note_after (NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION, insn);
8258 if (where == EMIT_NOTE_AFTER_CALL_INSN)
8259 NOTE_DURING_CALL_P (note) = true;
8261 else
8263 /* Make sure that the call related notes come first. */
8264 while (NEXT_INSN (insn)
8265 && NOTE_P (insn)
8266 && NOTE_DURING_CALL_P (insn))
8267 insn = NEXT_INSN (insn);
8268 if (NOTE_P (insn) && NOTE_DURING_CALL_P (insn))
8269 note = emit_note_after (NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION, insn);
8270 else
8271 note = emit_note_before (NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION, insn);
8273 NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (note) = note_vl;
8275 set_dv_changed (var->dv, false);
8276 gcc_assert (var->in_changed_variables);
8277 var->in_changed_variables = false;
8278 htab_clear_slot (changed_variables, varp);
8280 /* Continue traversing the hash table. */
8281 return 1;
8284 /* While traversing changed_variables, push onto DATA (a stack of RTX
8285 values) entries that aren't user variables. */
8287 static int
8288 values_to_stack (void **slot, void *data)
8290 VEC (rtx, stack) **changed_values_stack = (VEC (rtx, stack) **)data;
8291 variable var = (variable) *slot;
8293 if (var->onepart == ONEPART_VALUE)
8294 VEC_safe_push (rtx, stack, *changed_values_stack, dv_as_value (var->dv));
8295 else if (var->onepart == ONEPART_DEXPR)
8296 VEC_safe_push (rtx, stack, *changed_values_stack,
8297 DECL_RTL_KNOWN_SET (dv_as_decl (var->dv)));
8299 return 1;
8302 /* Remove from changed_variables the entry whose DV corresponds to
8303 value or debug_expr VAL. */
8304 static void
8305 remove_value_from_changed_variables (rtx val)
8307 decl_or_value dv = dv_from_rtx (val);
8308 void **slot;
8309 variable var;
8311 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (changed_variables,
8312 dv, dv_htab_hash (dv), NO_INSERT);
8313 var = (variable) *slot;
8314 var->in_changed_variables = false;
8315 htab_clear_slot (changed_variables, slot);
8318 /* If VAL (a value or debug_expr) has backlinks to variables actively
8319 dependent on it in HTAB or in CHANGED_VARIABLES, mark them as
8320 changed, adding to CHANGED_VALUES_STACK any dependencies that may
8321 have dependencies of their own to notify. */
8323 static void
8324 notify_dependents_of_changed_value (rtx val, htab_t htab,
8325 VEC (rtx, stack) **changed_values_stack)
8327 void **slot;
8328 variable var;
8329 loc_exp_dep *led;
8330 decl_or_value dv = dv_from_rtx (val);
8332 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (changed_variables,
8333 dv, dv_htab_hash (dv), NO_INSERT);
8334 if (!slot)
8335 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (htab,
8336 dv, dv_htab_hash (dv), NO_INSERT);
8337 if (!slot)
8338 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (dropped_values,
8339 dv, dv_htab_hash (dv), NO_INSERT);
8340 var = (variable) *slot;
8342 while ((led = VAR_LOC_DEP_LST (var)))
8344 decl_or_value ldv = led->dv;
8345 void **islot;
8346 variable ivar;
8348 /* Deactivate and remove the backlink, as it was “used up”. It
8349 makes no sense to attempt to notify the same entity again:
8350 either it will be recomputed and re-register an active
8351 dependency, or it will still have the changed mark. */
8352 if (led->next)
8353 led->next->pprev = led->pprev;
8354 if (led->pprev)
8355 *led->pprev = led->next;
8356 led->next = NULL;
8357 led->pprev = NULL;
8359 if (dv_changed_p (ldv))
8360 continue;
8362 switch (dv_onepart_p (ldv))
8364 case ONEPART_VALUE:
8365 case ONEPART_DEXPR:
8366 set_dv_changed (ldv, true);
8367 VEC_safe_push (rtx, stack, *changed_values_stack, dv_as_rtx (ldv));
8368 break;
8370 default:
8371 islot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (htab, ldv, dv_htab_hash (ldv),
8372 NO_INSERT);
8373 ivar = (variable) *islot;
8374 gcc_checking_assert (!VAR_LOC_DEP_LST (ivar));
8375 variable_was_changed (ivar, NULL);
8376 break;
8381 /* Take out of changed_variables any entries that don't refer to use
8382 variables. Back-propagate change notifications from values and
8383 debug_exprs to their active dependencies in HTAB or in
8384 CHANGED_VARIABLES. */
8386 static void
8387 process_changed_values (htab_t htab)
8389 int i, n;
8390 rtx val;
8391 VEC (rtx, stack) *changed_values_stack = VEC_alloc (rtx, stack, 20);
8393 /* Move values from changed_variables to changed_values_stack. */
8394 htab_traverse (changed_variables, values_to_stack, &changed_values_stack);
8396 /* Back-propagate change notifications in values while popping
8397 them from the stack. */
8398 for (n = i = VEC_length (rtx, changed_values_stack);
8399 i > 0; i = VEC_length (rtx, changed_values_stack))
8401 val = VEC_pop (rtx, changed_values_stack);
8402 notify_dependents_of_changed_value (val, htab, &changed_values_stack);
8404 /* This condition will hold when visiting each of the entries
8405 originally in changed_variables. We can't remove them
8406 earlier because this could drop the backlinks before we got a
8407 chance to use them. */
8408 if (i == n)
8410 remove_value_from_changed_variables (val);
8411 n--;
8415 VEC_free (rtx, stack, changed_values_stack);
8418 /* Emit NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION note for each variable from a chain
8419 CHANGED_VARIABLES and delete this chain. WHERE specifies whether
8420 the notes shall be emitted before of after instruction INSN. */
8422 static void
8423 emit_notes_for_changes (rtx insn, enum emit_note_where where,
8424 shared_hash vars)
8426 emit_note_data data;
8427 htab_t htab = shared_hash_htab (vars);
8429 if (!htab_elements (changed_variables))
8430 return;
8432 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_INSNS)
8433 process_changed_values (htab);
8435 data.insn = insn;
8436 data.where = where;
8437 data.vars = htab;
8439 htab_traverse (changed_variables, emit_note_insn_var_location, &data);
8442 /* Add variable *SLOT to the chain CHANGED_VARIABLES if it differs from the
8443 same variable in hash table DATA or is not there at all. */
8445 static int
8446 emit_notes_for_differences_1 (void **slot, void *data)
8448 htab_t new_vars = (htab_t) data;
8449 variable old_var, new_var;
8451 old_var = (variable) *slot;
8452 new_var = (variable) htab_find_with_hash (new_vars, old_var->dv,
8453 dv_htab_hash (old_var->dv));
8455 if (!new_var)
8457 /* Variable has disappeared. */
8458 variable empty_var = NULL;
8460 if (old_var->onepart == ONEPART_VALUE
8461 || old_var->onepart == ONEPART_DEXPR)
8463 empty_var = variable_from_dropped (old_var->dv, NO_INSERT);
8464 if (empty_var)
8466 gcc_checking_assert (!empty_var->in_changed_variables);
8467 if (!VAR_LOC_1PAUX (old_var))
8469 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (old_var) = VAR_LOC_1PAUX (empty_var);
8470 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (empty_var) = NULL;
8472 else
8473 gcc_checking_assert (!VAR_LOC_1PAUX (empty_var));
8477 if (!empty_var)
8479 empty_var = (variable) pool_alloc (onepart_pool (old_var->onepart));
8480 empty_var->dv = old_var->dv;
8481 empty_var->refcount = 0;
8482 empty_var->n_var_parts = 0;
8483 empty_var->onepart = old_var->onepart;
8484 empty_var->in_changed_variables = false;
8487 if (empty_var->onepart)
8489 /* Propagate the auxiliary data to (ultimately)
8490 changed_variables. */
8491 empty_var->var_part[0].loc_chain = NULL;
8492 empty_var->var_part[0].cur_loc = NULL;
8493 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (empty_var) = VAR_LOC_1PAUX (old_var);
8494 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (old_var) = NULL;
8496 variable_was_changed (empty_var, NULL);
8497 /* Continue traversing the hash table. */
8498 return 1;
8500 /* Update cur_loc and one-part auxiliary data, before new_var goes
8501 through variable_was_changed. */
8502 if (old_var != new_var && new_var->onepart)
8504 gcc_checking_assert (VAR_LOC_1PAUX (new_var) == NULL);
8505 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (new_var) = VAR_LOC_1PAUX (old_var);
8506 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (old_var) = NULL;
8507 new_var->var_part[0].cur_loc = old_var->var_part[0].cur_loc;
8509 if (variable_different_p (old_var, new_var))
8510 variable_was_changed (new_var, NULL);
8512 /* Continue traversing the hash table. */
8513 return 1;
8516 /* Add variable *SLOT to the chain CHANGED_VARIABLES if it is not in hash
8517 table DATA. */
8519 static int
8520 emit_notes_for_differences_2 (void **slot, void *data)
8522 htab_t old_vars = (htab_t) data;
8523 variable old_var, new_var;
8525 new_var = (variable) *slot;
8526 old_var = (variable) htab_find_with_hash (old_vars, new_var->dv,
8527 dv_htab_hash (new_var->dv));
8528 if (!old_var)
8530 int i;
8531 for (i = 0; i < new_var->n_var_parts; i++)
8532 new_var->var_part[i].cur_loc = NULL;
8533 variable_was_changed (new_var, NULL);
8536 /* Continue traversing the hash table. */
8537 return 1;
8540 /* Emit notes before INSN for differences between dataflow sets OLD_SET and
8541 NEW_SET. */
8543 static void
8544 emit_notes_for_differences (rtx insn, dataflow_set *old_set,
8545 dataflow_set *new_set)
8547 htab_traverse (shared_hash_htab (old_set->vars),
8548 emit_notes_for_differences_1,
8549 shared_hash_htab (new_set->vars));
8550 htab_traverse (shared_hash_htab (new_set->vars),
8551 emit_notes_for_differences_2,
8552 shared_hash_htab (old_set->vars));
8553 emit_notes_for_changes (insn, EMIT_NOTE_BEFORE_INSN, new_set->vars);
8556 /* Return the next insn after INSN that is not a NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION. */
8558 static rtx
8559 next_non_note_insn_var_location (rtx insn)
8561 while (insn)
8563 insn = NEXT_INSN (insn);
8564 if (insn == 0
8565 || !NOTE_P (insn)
8566 || NOTE_KIND (insn) != NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION)
8567 break;
8570 return insn;
8573 /* Emit the notes for changes of location parts in the basic block BB. */
8575 static void
8576 emit_notes_in_bb (basic_block bb, dataflow_set *set)
8578 unsigned int i;
8579 micro_operation *mo;
8581 dataflow_set_clear (set);
8582 dataflow_set_copy (set, &VTI (bb)->in);
8584 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (micro_operation, VTI (bb)->mos, i, mo)
8586 rtx insn = mo->insn;
8587 rtx next_insn = next_non_note_insn_var_location (insn);
8589 switch (mo->type)
8591 case MO_CALL:
8592 dataflow_set_clear_at_call (set);
8593 emit_notes_for_changes (insn, EMIT_NOTE_AFTER_CALL_INSN, set->vars);
8595 rtx arguments = mo->u.loc, *p = &arguments, note;
8596 while (*p)
8598 XEXP (XEXP (*p, 0), 1)
8599 = vt_expand_loc (XEXP (XEXP (*p, 0), 1),
8600 shared_hash_htab (set->vars));
8601 /* If expansion is successful, keep it in the list. */
8602 if (XEXP (XEXP (*p, 0), 1))
8603 p = &XEXP (*p, 1);
8604 /* Otherwise, if the following item is data_value for it,
8605 drop it too too. */
8606 else if (XEXP (*p, 1)
8607 && REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (*p, 0), 0))
8608 && MEM_P (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (*p, 1), 0), 0))
8609 && REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (*p, 1), 0), 0),
8611 && REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (*p, 0), 0))
8612 == REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (*p, 1), 0),
8613 0), 0)))
8614 *p = XEXP (XEXP (*p, 1), 1);
8615 /* Just drop this item. */
8616 else
8617 *p = XEXP (*p, 1);
8619 note = emit_note_after (NOTE_INSN_CALL_ARG_LOCATION, insn);
8620 NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (note) = arguments;
8622 break;
8624 case MO_USE:
8626 rtx loc = mo->u.loc;
8628 if (REG_P (loc))
8629 var_reg_set (set, loc, VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED, NULL);
8630 else
8631 var_mem_set (set, loc, VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED, NULL);
8633 emit_notes_for_changes (insn, EMIT_NOTE_AFTER_INSN, set->vars);
8635 break;
8637 case MO_VAL_LOC:
8639 rtx loc = mo->u.loc;
8640 rtx val, vloc;
8641 tree var;
8643 if (GET_CODE (loc) == CONCAT)
8645 val = XEXP (loc, 0);
8646 vloc = XEXP (loc, 1);
8648 else
8650 val = NULL_RTX;
8651 vloc = loc;
8654 var = PAT_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (vloc);
8656 clobber_variable_part (set, NULL_RTX,
8657 dv_from_decl (var), 0, NULL_RTX);
8658 if (val)
8660 if (VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION (loc))
8661 val_resolve (set, val, PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (vloc), insn);
8662 set_variable_part (set, val, dv_from_decl (var), 0,
8663 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED, NULL_RTX,
8664 INSERT);
8666 else if (!VAR_LOC_UNKNOWN_P (PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (vloc)))
8667 set_variable_part (set, PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (vloc),
8668 dv_from_decl (var), 0,
8669 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED, NULL_RTX,
8670 INSERT);
8672 emit_notes_for_changes (insn, EMIT_NOTE_AFTER_INSN, set->vars);
8674 break;
8676 case MO_VAL_USE:
8678 rtx loc = mo->u.loc;
8679 rtx val, vloc, uloc;
8681 vloc = uloc = XEXP (loc, 1);
8682 val = XEXP (loc, 0);
8684 if (GET_CODE (val) == CONCAT)
8686 uloc = XEXP (val, 1);
8687 val = XEXP (val, 0);
8690 if (VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION (loc))
8691 val_resolve (set, val, vloc, insn);
8692 else
8693 val_store (set, val, uloc, insn, false);
8695 if (VAL_HOLDS_TRACK_EXPR (loc))
8697 if (GET_CODE (uloc) == REG)
8698 var_reg_set (set, uloc, VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED,
8699 NULL);
8700 else if (GET_CODE (uloc) == MEM)
8701 var_mem_set (set, uloc, VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED,
8702 NULL);
8705 emit_notes_for_changes (insn, EMIT_NOTE_BEFORE_INSN, set->vars);
8707 break;
8709 case MO_VAL_SET:
8711 rtx loc = mo->u.loc;
8712 rtx val, vloc, uloc, reverse = NULL_RTX;
8714 vloc = loc;
8715 if (VAL_EXPR_HAS_REVERSE (loc))
8717 reverse = XEXP (loc, 1);
8718 vloc = XEXP (loc, 0);
8720 uloc = XEXP (vloc, 1);
8721 val = XEXP (vloc, 0);
8722 vloc = uloc;
8724 if (GET_CODE (val) == CONCAT)
8726 vloc = XEXP (val, 1);
8727 val = XEXP (val, 0);
8730 if (GET_CODE (vloc) == SET)
8732 rtx vsrc = SET_SRC (vloc);
8734 gcc_assert (val != vsrc);
8735 gcc_assert (vloc == uloc || VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION (loc));
8737 vloc = SET_DEST (vloc);
8739 if (VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION (loc))
8740 val_resolve (set, val, vsrc, insn);
8742 else if (VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION (loc))
8744 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (uloc) == SET
8745 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (uloc)) == REG);
8746 val_resolve (set, val, SET_SRC (uloc), insn);
8749 if (VAL_HOLDS_TRACK_EXPR (loc))
8751 if (VAL_EXPR_IS_CLOBBERED (loc))
8753 if (REG_P (uloc))
8754 var_reg_delete (set, uloc, true);
8755 else if (MEM_P (uloc))
8756 var_mem_delete (set, uloc, true);
8758 else
8760 bool copied_p = VAL_EXPR_IS_COPIED (loc);
8761 rtx set_src = NULL;
8762 enum var_init_status status = VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED;
8764 if (GET_CODE (uloc) == SET)
8766 set_src = SET_SRC (uloc);
8767 uloc = SET_DEST (uloc);
8770 if (copied_p)
8772 status = find_src_status (set, set_src);
8774 set_src = find_src_set_src (set, set_src);
8777 if (REG_P (uloc))
8778 var_reg_delete_and_set (set, uloc, !copied_p,
8779 status, set_src);
8780 else if (MEM_P (uloc))
8781 var_mem_delete_and_set (set, uloc, !copied_p,
8782 status, set_src);
8785 else if (REG_P (uloc))
8786 var_regno_delete (set, REGNO (uloc));
8788 val_store (set, val, vloc, insn, true);
8790 if (reverse)
8791 val_store (set, XEXP (reverse, 0), XEXP (reverse, 1),
8792 insn, false);
8794 emit_notes_for_changes (next_insn, EMIT_NOTE_BEFORE_INSN,
8795 set->vars);
8797 break;
8799 case MO_SET:
8801 rtx loc = mo->u.loc;
8802 rtx set_src = NULL;
8804 if (GET_CODE (loc) == SET)
8806 set_src = SET_SRC (loc);
8807 loc = SET_DEST (loc);
8810 if (REG_P (loc))
8811 var_reg_delete_and_set (set, loc, true, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED,
8812 set_src);
8813 else
8814 var_mem_delete_and_set (set, loc, true, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED,
8815 set_src);
8817 emit_notes_for_changes (next_insn, EMIT_NOTE_BEFORE_INSN,
8818 set->vars);
8820 break;
8822 case MO_COPY:
8824 rtx loc = mo->u.loc;
8825 enum var_init_status src_status;
8826 rtx set_src = NULL;
8828 if (GET_CODE (loc) == SET)
8830 set_src = SET_SRC (loc);
8831 loc = SET_DEST (loc);
8834 src_status = find_src_status (set, set_src);
8835 set_src = find_src_set_src (set, set_src);
8837 if (REG_P (loc))
8838 var_reg_delete_and_set (set, loc, false, src_status, set_src);
8839 else
8840 var_mem_delete_and_set (set, loc, false, src_status, set_src);
8842 emit_notes_for_changes (next_insn, EMIT_NOTE_BEFORE_INSN,
8843 set->vars);
8845 break;
8847 case MO_USE_NO_VAR:
8849 rtx loc = mo->u.loc;
8851 if (REG_P (loc))
8852 var_reg_delete (set, loc, false);
8853 else
8854 var_mem_delete (set, loc, false);
8856 emit_notes_for_changes (insn, EMIT_NOTE_AFTER_INSN, set->vars);
8858 break;
8860 case MO_CLOBBER:
8862 rtx loc = mo->u.loc;
8864 if (REG_P (loc))
8865 var_reg_delete (set, loc, true);
8866 else
8867 var_mem_delete (set, loc, true);
8869 emit_notes_for_changes (next_insn, EMIT_NOTE_BEFORE_INSN,
8870 set->vars);
8872 break;
8874 case MO_ADJUST:
8875 set->stack_adjust += mo->u.adjust;
8876 break;
8881 /* Emit notes for the whole function. */
8883 static void
8884 vt_emit_notes (void)
8886 basic_block bb;
8887 dataflow_set cur;
8889 gcc_assert (!htab_elements (changed_variables));
8891 /* Free memory occupied by the out hash tables, as they aren't used
8892 anymore. */
8893 FOR_EACH_BB (bb)
8894 dataflow_set_clear (&VTI (bb)->out);
8896 /* Enable emitting notes by functions (mainly by set_variable_part and
8897 delete_variable_part). */
8898 emit_notes = true;
8900 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_INSNS)
8901 dropped_values = htab_create (cselib_get_next_uid () * 2,
8902 variable_htab_hash, variable_htab_eq,
8903 variable_htab_free);
8905 dataflow_set_init (&cur);
8907 FOR_EACH_BB (bb)
8909 /* Emit the notes for changes of variable locations between two
8910 subsequent basic blocks. */
8911 emit_notes_for_differences (BB_HEAD (bb), &cur, &VTI (bb)->in);
8913 /* Emit the notes for the changes in the basic block itself. */
8914 emit_notes_in_bb (bb, &cur);
8916 /* Free memory occupied by the in hash table, we won't need it
8917 again. */
8918 dataflow_set_clear (&VTI (bb)->in);
8920 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
8921 htab_traverse (shared_hash_htab (cur.vars),
8922 emit_notes_for_differences_1,
8923 shared_hash_htab (empty_shared_hash));
8924 #endif
8925 dataflow_set_destroy (&cur);
8927 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_INSNS)
8928 htab_delete (dropped_values);
8930 emit_notes = false;
8933 /* If there is a declaration and offset associated with register/memory RTL
8934 assign declaration to *DECLP and offset to *OFFSETP, and return true. */
8936 static bool
8937 vt_get_decl_and_offset (rtx rtl, tree *declp, HOST_WIDE_INT *offsetp)
8939 if (REG_P (rtl))
8941 if (REG_ATTRS (rtl))
8943 *declp = REG_EXPR (rtl);
8944 *offsetp = REG_OFFSET (rtl);
8945 return true;
8948 else if (MEM_P (rtl))
8950 if (MEM_ATTRS (rtl))
8952 *declp = MEM_EXPR (rtl);
8953 *offsetp = INT_MEM_OFFSET (rtl);
8954 return true;
8957 return false;
8960 /* Mark the value for the ENTRY_VALUE of RTL as equivalent to EQVAL in
8961 OUT. */
8963 static void
8964 create_entry_value (dataflow_set *out, rtx eqval, rtx rtl)
8966 rtx ev = gen_rtx_ENTRY_VALUE (GET_MODE (rtl));
8967 cselib_val *val;
8969 ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (ev) = rtl;
8971 val = cselib_lookup_from_insn (ev, GET_MODE (ev), true,
8972 VOIDmode, get_insns ());
8974 if (val->val_rtx != eqval)
8976 preserve_value (val);
8977 set_variable_part (out, val->val_rtx, dv_from_value (eqval), 0,
8978 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED, NULL_RTX, INSERT);
8979 set_variable_part (out, eqval, dv_from_value (val->val_rtx), 0,
8980 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED, NULL_RTX, INSERT);
8984 /* Insert function parameter PARM in IN and OUT sets of ENTRY_BLOCK. */
8986 static void
8987 vt_add_function_parameter (tree parm)
8989 rtx decl_rtl = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (parm);
8990 rtx incoming = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (parm);
8991 tree decl;
8992 enum machine_mode mode;
8993 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
8994 dataflow_set *out;
8995 decl_or_value dv;
8997 if (TREE_CODE (parm) != PARM_DECL)
8998 return;
9000 if (!decl_rtl || !incoming)
9001 return;
9003 if (GET_MODE (decl_rtl) == BLKmode || GET_MODE (incoming) == BLKmode)
9004 return;
9006 /* If there is a DRAP register, rewrite the incoming location of parameters
9007 passed on the stack into MEMs based on the argument pointer, as the DRAP
9008 register can be reused for other purposes and we do not track locations
9009 based on generic registers. But the prerequisite is that this argument
9010 pointer be also the virtual CFA pointer, see vt_initialize. */
9011 if (MEM_P (incoming)
9012 && stack_realign_drap
9013 && arg_pointer_rtx == cfa_base_rtx
9014 && (XEXP (incoming, 0) == crtl->args.internal_arg_pointer
9015 || (GET_CODE (XEXP (incoming, 0)) == PLUS
9016 && XEXP (XEXP (incoming, 0), 0)
9017 == crtl->args.internal_arg_pointer
9018 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (XEXP (incoming, 0), 1)))))
9020 HOST_WIDE_INT off = -FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
9021 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (incoming, 0)) == PLUS)
9022 off += INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (incoming, 0), 1));
9023 incoming
9024 = replace_equiv_address_nv (incoming,
9025 plus_constant (arg_pointer_rtx, off));
9028 #ifdef HAVE_window_save
9029 /* DECL_INCOMING_RTL uses the INCOMING_REGNO of parameter registers.
9030 If the target machine has an explicit window save instruction, the
9031 actual entry value is the corresponding OUTGOING_REGNO instead. */
9032 if (REG_P (incoming)
9033 && HARD_REGISTER_P (incoming)
9034 && OUTGOING_REGNO (REGNO (incoming)) != REGNO (incoming))
9036 parm_reg_t *p
9037 = VEC_safe_push (parm_reg_t, gc, windowed_parm_regs, NULL);
9038 p->incoming = incoming;
9039 incoming
9040 = gen_rtx_REG_offset (incoming, GET_MODE (incoming),
9041 OUTGOING_REGNO (REGNO (incoming)), 0);
9042 p->outgoing = incoming;
9044 else if (MEM_P (incoming)
9045 && REG_P (XEXP (incoming, 0))
9046 && HARD_REGISTER_P (XEXP (incoming, 0)))
9048 rtx reg = XEXP (incoming, 0);
9049 if (OUTGOING_REGNO (REGNO (reg)) != REGNO (reg))
9051 parm_reg_t *p
9052 = VEC_safe_push (parm_reg_t, gc, windowed_parm_regs, NULL);
9053 p->incoming = reg;
9054 reg = gen_raw_REG (GET_MODE (reg), OUTGOING_REGNO (REGNO (reg)));
9055 p->outgoing = reg;
9056 incoming = replace_equiv_address_nv (incoming, reg);
9059 #endif
9061 if (!vt_get_decl_and_offset (incoming, &decl, &offset))
9063 if (REG_P (incoming) || MEM_P (incoming))
9065 /* This means argument is passed by invisible reference. */
9066 offset = 0;
9067 decl = parm;
9068 incoming = gen_rtx_MEM (GET_MODE (decl_rtl), incoming);
9070 else
9072 if (!vt_get_decl_and_offset (decl_rtl, &decl, &offset))
9073 return;
9074 offset += byte_lowpart_offset (GET_MODE (incoming),
9075 GET_MODE (decl_rtl));
9079 if (!decl)
9080 return;
9082 if (parm != decl)
9084 /* Assume that DECL_RTL was a pseudo that got spilled to
9085 memory. The spill slot sharing code will force the
9086 memory to reference spill_slot_decl (%sfp), so we don't
9087 match above. That's ok, the pseudo must have referenced
9088 the entire parameter, so just reset OFFSET. */
9089 gcc_assert (decl == get_spill_slot_decl (false));
9090 offset = 0;
9093 if (!track_loc_p (incoming, parm, offset, false, &mode, &offset))
9094 return;
9096 out = &VTI (ENTRY_BLOCK_PTR)->out;
9098 dv = dv_from_decl (parm);
9100 if (target_for_debug_bind (parm)
9101 /* We can't deal with these right now, because this kind of
9102 variable is single-part. ??? We could handle parallels
9103 that describe multiple locations for the same single
9104 value, but ATM we don't. */
9105 && GET_CODE (incoming) != PARALLEL)
9107 cselib_val *val;
9109 /* ??? We shouldn't ever hit this, but it may happen because
9110 arguments passed by invisible reference aren't dealt with
9111 above: incoming-rtl will have Pmode rather than the
9112 expected mode for the type. */
9113 if (offset)
9114 return;
9116 val = cselib_lookup_from_insn (var_lowpart (mode, incoming), mode, true,
9117 VOIDmode, get_insns ());
9119 /* ??? Float-typed values in memory are not handled by
9120 cselib. */
9121 if (val)
9123 preserve_value (val);
9124 set_variable_part (out, val->val_rtx, dv, offset,
9125 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED, NULL, INSERT);
9126 dv = dv_from_value (val->val_rtx);
9130 if (REG_P (incoming))
9132 incoming = var_lowpart (mode, incoming);
9133 gcc_assert (REGNO (incoming) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER);
9134 attrs_list_insert (&out->regs[REGNO (incoming)], dv, offset,
9135 incoming);
9136 set_variable_part (out, incoming, dv, offset,
9137 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED, NULL, INSERT);
9138 if (dv_is_value_p (dv))
9140 create_entry_value (out, dv_as_value (dv), incoming);
9141 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (parm)) == REFERENCE_TYPE
9142 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (parm))))
9144 enum machine_mode indmode
9145 = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (parm)));
9146 rtx mem = gen_rtx_MEM (indmode, incoming);
9147 cselib_val *val = cselib_lookup_from_insn (mem, indmode, true,
9148 VOIDmode,
9149 get_insns ());
9150 if (val)
9152 preserve_value (val);
9153 set_variable_part (out, mem, dv_from_value (val->val_rtx), 0,
9154 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED, NULL, INSERT);
9155 create_entry_value (out, val->val_rtx, mem);
9160 else if (MEM_P (incoming))
9162 incoming = var_lowpart (mode, incoming);
9163 set_variable_part (out, incoming, dv, offset,
9164 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED, NULL, INSERT);
9168 /* Insert function parameters to IN and OUT sets of ENTRY_BLOCK. */
9170 static void
9171 vt_add_function_parameters (void)
9173 tree parm;
9175 for (parm = DECL_ARGUMENTS (current_function_decl);
9176 parm; parm = DECL_CHAIN (parm))
9177 vt_add_function_parameter (parm);
9179 if (DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P (DECL_RESULT (current_function_decl)))
9181 tree vexpr = DECL_VALUE_EXPR (DECL_RESULT (current_function_decl));
9183 if (TREE_CODE (vexpr) == INDIRECT_REF)
9184 vexpr = TREE_OPERAND (vexpr, 0);
9186 if (TREE_CODE (vexpr) == PARM_DECL
9187 && DECL_ARTIFICIAL (vexpr)
9188 && !DECL_IGNORED_P (vexpr)
9189 && DECL_NAMELESS (vexpr))
9190 vt_add_function_parameter (vexpr);
9194 /* Return true if INSN in the prologue initializes hard_frame_pointer_rtx. */
9196 static bool
9197 fp_setter (rtx insn)
9199 rtx pat = PATTERN (insn);
9200 if (RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn))
9202 rtx expr = find_reg_note (insn, REG_FRAME_RELATED_EXPR, NULL_RTX);
9203 if (expr)
9204 pat = XEXP (expr, 0);
9206 if (GET_CODE (pat) == SET)
9207 return SET_DEST (pat) == hard_frame_pointer_rtx;
9208 else if (GET_CODE (pat) == PARALLEL)
9210 int i;
9211 for (i = XVECLEN (pat, 0) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
9212 if (GET_CODE (XVECEXP (pat, 0, i)) == SET
9213 && SET_DEST (XVECEXP (pat, 0, i)) == hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
9214 return true;
9216 return false;
9219 /* Initialize cfa_base_rtx, create a preserved VALUE for it and
9220 ensure it isn't flushed during cselib_reset_table.
9221 Can be called only if frame_pointer_rtx resp. arg_pointer_rtx
9222 has been eliminated. */
9224 static void
9225 vt_init_cfa_base (void)
9227 cselib_val *val;
9229 #ifdef FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET
9230 cfa_base_rtx = frame_pointer_rtx;
9231 cfa_base_offset = -FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
9232 #else
9233 cfa_base_rtx = arg_pointer_rtx;
9234 cfa_base_offset = -ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
9235 #endif
9236 if (cfa_base_rtx == hard_frame_pointer_rtx
9237 || !fixed_regs[REGNO (cfa_base_rtx)])
9239 cfa_base_rtx = NULL_RTX;
9240 return;
9242 if (!MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_INSNS)
9243 return;
9245 /* Tell alias analysis that cfa_base_rtx should share
9246 find_base_term value with stack pointer or hard frame pointer. */
9247 if (!frame_pointer_needed)
9248 vt_equate_reg_base_value (cfa_base_rtx, stack_pointer_rtx);
9249 else if (!crtl->stack_realign_tried)
9250 vt_equate_reg_base_value (cfa_base_rtx, hard_frame_pointer_rtx);
9252 val = cselib_lookup_from_insn (cfa_base_rtx, GET_MODE (cfa_base_rtx), 1,
9253 VOIDmode, get_insns ());
9254 preserve_value (val);
9255 cselib_preserve_cfa_base_value (val, REGNO (cfa_base_rtx));
9256 var_reg_decl_set (&VTI (ENTRY_BLOCK_PTR)->out, cfa_base_rtx,
9257 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED, dv_from_value (val->val_rtx),
9258 0, NULL_RTX, INSERT);
9261 /* Allocate and initialize the data structures for variable tracking
9262 and parse the RTL to get the micro operations. */
9264 static bool
9265 vt_initialize (void)
9267 basic_block bb, prologue_bb = single_succ (ENTRY_BLOCK_PTR);
9268 HOST_WIDE_INT fp_cfa_offset = -1;
9270 alloc_aux_for_blocks (sizeof (struct variable_tracking_info_def));
9272 attrs_pool = create_alloc_pool ("attrs_def pool",
9273 sizeof (struct attrs_def), 1024);
9274 var_pool = create_alloc_pool ("variable_def pool",
9275 sizeof (struct variable_def)
9276 + (MAX_VAR_PARTS - 1)
9277 * sizeof (((variable)NULL)->var_part[0]), 64);
9278 loc_chain_pool = create_alloc_pool ("location_chain_def pool",
9279 sizeof (struct location_chain_def),
9280 1024);
9281 shared_hash_pool = create_alloc_pool ("shared_hash_def pool",
9282 sizeof (struct shared_hash_def), 256);
9283 empty_shared_hash = (shared_hash) pool_alloc (shared_hash_pool);
9284 empty_shared_hash->refcount = 1;
9285 empty_shared_hash->htab
9286 = htab_create (1, variable_htab_hash, variable_htab_eq,
9287 variable_htab_free);
9288 changed_variables = htab_create (10, variable_htab_hash, variable_htab_eq,
9289 variable_htab_free);
9291 /* Init the IN and OUT sets. */
9292 FOR_ALL_BB (bb)
9294 VTI (bb)->visited = false;
9295 VTI (bb)->flooded = false;
9296 dataflow_set_init (&VTI (bb)->in);
9297 dataflow_set_init (&VTI (bb)->out);
9298 VTI (bb)->permp = NULL;
9301 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_INSNS)
9303 cselib_init (CSELIB_RECORD_MEMORY | CSELIB_PRESERVE_CONSTANTS);
9304 scratch_regs = BITMAP_ALLOC (NULL);
9305 valvar_pool = create_alloc_pool ("small variable_def pool",
9306 sizeof (struct variable_def), 256);
9307 preserved_values = VEC_alloc (rtx, heap, 256);
9309 else
9311 scratch_regs = NULL;
9312 valvar_pool = NULL;
9315 /* In order to factor out the adjustments made to the stack pointer or to
9316 the hard frame pointer and thus be able to use DW_OP_fbreg operations
9317 instead of individual location lists, we're going to rewrite MEMs based
9318 on them into MEMs based on the CFA by de-eliminating stack_pointer_rtx
9319 or hard_frame_pointer_rtx to the virtual CFA pointer frame_pointer_rtx
9320 resp. arg_pointer_rtx. We can do this either when there is no frame
9321 pointer in the function and stack adjustments are consistent for all
9322 basic blocks or when there is a frame pointer and no stack realignment.
9323 But we first have to check that frame_pointer_rtx resp. arg_pointer_rtx
9324 has been eliminated. */
9325 if (!frame_pointer_needed)
9327 rtx reg, elim;
9329 if (!vt_stack_adjustments ())
9330 return false;
9332 #ifdef FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET
9333 reg = frame_pointer_rtx;
9334 #else
9335 reg = arg_pointer_rtx;
9336 #endif
9337 elim = eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX);
9338 if (elim != reg)
9340 if (GET_CODE (elim) == PLUS)
9341 elim = XEXP (elim, 0);
9342 if (elim == stack_pointer_rtx)
9343 vt_init_cfa_base ();
9346 else if (!crtl->stack_realign_tried)
9348 rtx reg, elim;
9350 #ifdef FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET
9351 reg = frame_pointer_rtx;
9352 fp_cfa_offset = FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
9353 #else
9354 reg = arg_pointer_rtx;
9355 fp_cfa_offset = ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
9356 #endif
9357 elim = eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX);
9358 if (elim != reg)
9360 if (GET_CODE (elim) == PLUS)
9362 fp_cfa_offset -= INTVAL (XEXP (elim, 1));
9363 elim = XEXP (elim, 0);
9365 if (elim != hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
9366 fp_cfa_offset = -1;
9368 else
9369 fp_cfa_offset = -1;
9372 /* If the stack is realigned and a DRAP register is used, we're going to
9373 rewrite MEMs based on it representing incoming locations of parameters
9374 passed on the stack into MEMs based on the argument pointer. Although
9375 we aren't going to rewrite other MEMs, we still need to initialize the
9376 virtual CFA pointer in order to ensure that the argument pointer will
9377 be seen as a constant throughout the function.
9379 ??? This doesn't work if FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET is defined. */
9380 else if (stack_realign_drap)
9382 rtx reg, elim;
9384 #ifdef FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET
9385 reg = frame_pointer_rtx;
9386 #else
9387 reg = arg_pointer_rtx;
9388 #endif
9389 elim = eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX);
9390 if (elim != reg)
9392 if (GET_CODE (elim) == PLUS)
9393 elim = XEXP (elim, 0);
9394 if (elim == hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
9395 vt_init_cfa_base ();
9399 hard_frame_pointer_adjustment = -1;
9401 vt_add_function_parameters ();
9403 FOR_EACH_BB (bb)
9405 rtx insn;
9406 HOST_WIDE_INT pre, post = 0;
9407 basic_block first_bb, last_bb;
9409 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_INSNS)
9411 cselib_record_sets_hook = add_with_sets;
9412 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
9413 fprintf (dump_file, "first value: %i\n",
9414 cselib_get_next_uid ());
9417 first_bb = bb;
9418 for (;;)
9420 edge e;
9421 if (bb->next_bb == EXIT_BLOCK_PTR
9422 || ! single_pred_p (bb->next_bb))
9423 break;
9424 e = find_edge (bb, bb->next_bb);
9425 if (! e || (e->flags & EDGE_FALLTHRU) == 0)
9426 break;
9427 bb = bb->next_bb;
9429 last_bb = bb;
9431 /* Add the micro-operations to the vector. */
9432 FOR_BB_BETWEEN (bb, first_bb, last_bb->next_bb, next_bb)
9434 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = VTI (bb)->out.stack_adjust;
9435 VTI (bb)->out.stack_adjust = VTI (bb)->in.stack_adjust;
9436 for (insn = BB_HEAD (bb); insn != NEXT_INSN (BB_END (bb));
9437 insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
9439 if (INSN_P (insn))
9441 if (!frame_pointer_needed)
9443 insn_stack_adjust_offset_pre_post (insn, &pre, &post);
9444 if (pre)
9446 micro_operation mo;
9447 mo.type = MO_ADJUST;
9448 mo.u.adjust = pre;
9449 mo.insn = insn;
9450 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
9451 log_op_type (PATTERN (insn), bb, insn,
9452 MO_ADJUST, dump_file);
9453 VEC_safe_push (micro_operation, heap, VTI (bb)->mos,
9454 &mo);
9455 VTI (bb)->out.stack_adjust += pre;
9459 cselib_hook_called = false;
9460 adjust_insn (bb, insn);
9461 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_INSNS)
9463 if (CALL_P (insn))
9464 prepare_call_arguments (bb, insn);
9465 cselib_process_insn (insn);
9466 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
9468 print_rtl_single (dump_file, insn);
9469 dump_cselib_table (dump_file);
9472 if (!cselib_hook_called)
9473 add_with_sets (insn, 0, 0);
9474 cancel_changes (0);
9476 if (!frame_pointer_needed && post)
9478 micro_operation mo;
9479 mo.type = MO_ADJUST;
9480 mo.u.adjust = post;
9481 mo.insn = insn;
9482 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
9483 log_op_type (PATTERN (insn), bb, insn,
9484 MO_ADJUST, dump_file);
9485 VEC_safe_push (micro_operation, heap, VTI (bb)->mos,
9486 &mo);
9487 VTI (bb)->out.stack_adjust += post;
9490 if (bb == prologue_bb
9491 && fp_cfa_offset != -1
9492 && hard_frame_pointer_adjustment == -1
9493 && RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn)
9494 && fp_setter (insn))
9496 vt_init_cfa_base ();
9497 hard_frame_pointer_adjustment = fp_cfa_offset;
9501 gcc_assert (offset == VTI (bb)->out.stack_adjust);
9504 bb = last_bb;
9506 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_INSNS)
9508 cselib_preserve_only_values ();
9509 cselib_reset_table (cselib_get_next_uid ());
9510 cselib_record_sets_hook = NULL;
9514 hard_frame_pointer_adjustment = -1;
9515 VTI (ENTRY_BLOCK_PTR)->flooded = true;
9516 cfa_base_rtx = NULL_RTX;
9517 return true;
9520 /* This is *not* reset after each function. It gives each
9521 NOTE_INSN_DELETED_DEBUG_LABEL in the entire compilation
9522 a unique label number. */
9524 static int debug_label_num = 1;
9526 /* Get rid of all debug insns from the insn stream. */
9528 static void
9529 delete_debug_insns (void)
9531 basic_block bb;
9532 rtx insn, next;
9534 if (!MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_INSNS)
9535 return;
9537 FOR_EACH_BB (bb)
9539 FOR_BB_INSNS_SAFE (bb, insn, next)
9540 if (DEBUG_INSN_P (insn))
9542 tree decl = INSN_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (insn);
9543 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == LABEL_DECL
9544 && DECL_NAME (decl)
9545 && !DECL_RTL_SET_P (decl))
9547 PUT_CODE (insn, NOTE);
9548 NOTE_KIND (insn) = NOTE_INSN_DELETED_DEBUG_LABEL;
9549 NOTE_DELETED_LABEL_NAME (insn)
9550 = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (decl));
9551 SET_DECL_RTL (decl, insn);
9552 CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (insn) = debug_label_num++;
9554 else
9555 delete_insn (insn);
9560 /* Run a fast, BB-local only version of var tracking, to take care of
9561 information that we don't do global analysis on, such that not all
9562 information is lost. If SKIPPED holds, we're skipping the global
9563 pass entirely, so we should try to use information it would have
9564 handled as well.. */
9566 static void
9567 vt_debug_insns_local (bool skipped ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9569 /* ??? Just skip it all for now. */
9570 delete_debug_insns ();
9573 /* Free the data structures needed for variable tracking. */
9575 static void
9576 vt_finalize (void)
9578 basic_block bb;
9580 FOR_EACH_BB (bb)
9582 VEC_free (micro_operation, heap, VTI (bb)->mos);
9585 FOR_ALL_BB (bb)
9587 dataflow_set_destroy (&VTI (bb)->in);
9588 dataflow_set_destroy (&VTI (bb)->out);
9589 if (VTI (bb)->permp)
9591 dataflow_set_destroy (VTI (bb)->permp);
9592 XDELETE (VTI (bb)->permp);
9595 free_aux_for_blocks ();
9596 htab_delete (empty_shared_hash->htab);
9597 htab_delete (changed_variables);
9598 free_alloc_pool (attrs_pool);
9599 free_alloc_pool (var_pool);
9600 free_alloc_pool (loc_chain_pool);
9601 free_alloc_pool (shared_hash_pool);
9603 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_INSNS)
9605 free_alloc_pool (valvar_pool);
9606 VEC_free (rtx, heap, preserved_values);
9607 cselib_finish ();
9608 BITMAP_FREE (scratch_regs);
9609 scratch_regs = NULL;
9612 #ifdef HAVE_window_save
9613 VEC_free (parm_reg_t, gc, windowed_parm_regs);
9614 #endif
9616 if (vui_vec)
9617 XDELETEVEC (vui_vec);
9618 vui_vec = NULL;
9619 vui_allocated = 0;
9622 /* The entry point to variable tracking pass. */
9624 static inline unsigned int
9625 variable_tracking_main_1 (void)
9627 bool success;
9629 if (flag_var_tracking_assignments < 0)
9631 delete_debug_insns ();
9632 return 0;
9635 if (n_basic_blocks > 500 && n_edges / n_basic_blocks >= 20)
9637 vt_debug_insns_local (true);
9638 return 0;
9641 mark_dfs_back_edges ();
9642 if (!vt_initialize ())
9644 vt_finalize ();
9645 vt_debug_insns_local (true);
9646 return 0;
9649 success = vt_find_locations ();
9651 if (!success && flag_var_tracking_assignments > 0)
9653 vt_finalize ();
9655 delete_debug_insns ();
9657 /* This is later restored by our caller. */
9658 flag_var_tracking_assignments = 0;
9660 success = vt_initialize ();
9661 gcc_assert (success);
9663 success = vt_find_locations ();
9666 if (!success)
9668 vt_finalize ();
9669 vt_debug_insns_local (false);
9670 return 0;
9673 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
9675 dump_dataflow_sets ();
9676 dump_flow_info (dump_file, dump_flags);
9679 timevar_push (TV_VAR_TRACKING_EMIT);
9680 vt_emit_notes ();
9681 timevar_pop (TV_VAR_TRACKING_EMIT);
9683 vt_finalize ();
9684 vt_debug_insns_local (false);
9685 return 0;
9688 unsigned int
9689 variable_tracking_main (void)
9691 unsigned int ret;
9692 int save = flag_var_tracking_assignments;
9694 ret = variable_tracking_main_1 ();
9696 flag_var_tracking_assignments = save;
9698 return ret;
9701 static bool
9702 gate_handle_var_tracking (void)
9704 return (flag_var_tracking && !targetm.delay_vartrack);
9709 struct rtl_opt_pass pass_variable_tracking =
9712 RTL_PASS,
9713 "vartrack", /* name */
9714 gate_handle_var_tracking, /* gate */
9715 variable_tracking_main, /* execute */
9716 NULL, /* sub */
9717 NULL, /* next */
9718 0, /* static_pass_number */
9719 TV_VAR_TRACKING, /* tv_id */
9720 0, /* properties_required */
9721 0, /* properties_provided */
9722 0, /* properties_destroyed */
9723 0, /* todo_flags_start */
9724 TODO_verify_rtl_sharing /* todo_flags_finish */